Yamaha | BD-S673 | manual | Yamaha BD-S673 User manual

P
Blu-ray Disc Player
BD-S673
BD-S673
Owner’s Manual
Manual de Instrucciones
English
Español
USB
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation
Printed in China BD-S673/P
Caution: Read this before operating your unit.
1
2
3
4
5
To assure the finest performance, please read this manual
carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference.
Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean
place-away from direct sunlight, heat sources, vibration, dust,
moisture, and/or cold. For proper ventilation, allow the
following minimum clearances.
Top : 10 cm (4 in)
Rear: 10 cm (4 in)
Side: 10 cm (4 in)
Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances,
motors, or transformers to avoid humming sounds.
Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from
cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in an environment with
high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent
condensation inside this unit, which may cause an electrical
shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
Avoid installing this unit where foreign object may fall onto
this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to liquid dripping or
splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place:
– Other components, as they may cause damage and/or
discoloration on the surface of this unit.
– Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire,
damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
– Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and
liquid may cause electrical shock to the user and/or
damage to this unit.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain,
etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If the temperature
inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit,
and/or personal injury.
Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections
are complete.
Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat,
possibly causing damage.
Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords.
When disconnecting the power cable from the wall outlet,
grasp the plug; do not pull the cable.
Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might
damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth.
Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this
unit with a higher voltage than specified is dangerous and
may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
Yamaha will not be held responsible for any damage resulting
from use of this unit with a voltage other than specified.
To prevent damage by lightning, keep the power cable
disconnected from a wall outlet or this unit during a lightning
storm.
Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified
Yamaha service personnel when any service is needed. The
cabinet should never be opened for any reasons.
When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time
(i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power plug from the wall
outlet.
Be sure to read the “Troubleshooting” section on common
operating errors before concluding that this unit is faulty.
Before moving this unit, press p to set this unit to the
standby mode, and disconnect the AC power plug from the
wall outlet.
Caution-i En
18 Condensation will form when the surrounding temperature
changes suddenly. Disconnect the power cable from the
outlet, then leave this unit alone.
19 When using this unit for a long time, this unit may become
warm. Turn the power off, then leave this unit alone for
cooling.
20 Install this unit near the AC outlet and where the AC power
plug can be reached easily.
21 The batteries shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as
sunshine, fire or the like.
Do not use this unit within 22 cm (9 inches) of persons
with a heart pacemaker implant or defibrillator implant.
This unit is not disconnected from the AC power source
as long as it is connected to the wall outlet, even if this
unit itself is turned off by p. This state is called the
standby mode. In this state, this unit is designed to
consume a very small quantity of power.
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC
SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN OR
MOISTURE.
The laser component in this product is capable of
emitting radiation exceeding the limit for Class 1.
This equipment operates on a secondary basis and,
consequently, must accept harmful interference,
including from station of the same kind, and may not
cause harmful interference to systems operating on a
primary basis.
Contents
1. Introduction
1
4. Settings
What you can do with this Player ..................... 2
Supplied parts .................................................... 2
About discs and files ......................................... 3
SETUP menu ..................................................... 28
3
4
4
4
4
Example of SETUP menu operation............................. 30
General Setting.............................................................. 31
Display Setting.............................................................. 33
Audio Setting ................................................................ 35
System Information....................................................... 35
About the audio output formats .................................... 36
About the video output formats .................................... 37
Controls and functions ...................................... 5
Software upgrade ............................................. 38
Front panel...................................................................... 5
Remote control ............................................................... 6
Upgrading the software ................................................. 38
Types of discs/files that can be used with this Player ....
Loading a disc.................................................................
Disc precautions .............................................................
Notice for watching 3D video images ............................
Cinavia technology.........................................................
Rear panel ..................................................................... 10
HDMI connection .............................................. 12
Connecting to the HDMI terminal................................ 12
Connection for the playback of Blu-ray 3D Discs ....... 12
Video connections ........................................... 13
Connecting to the component/video jack ..................... 13
Audio connections ........................................... 14
Connecting to the digital audio jack/terminal............... 14
Connecting to the audio jacks....................................... 15
Power ............................................................................ 39
Basic operation.............................................................. 39
Disc playback................................................................ 39
Picture ........................................................................... 40
Sound ............................................................................ 40
Network......................................................................... 40
Messages on the screen ................................................. 41
Glossary ............................................................ 42
Specifications ................................................... 43
Connecting to the NETWORK terminal ...................... 16
Connecting to the USB connector ................................ 16
General .......................................................................... 43
Audio performance ....................................................... 43
Input/output................................................................... 43
Copyright ...................................................................... 44
Other connections ........................................... 17
Index .................................................................. 45
Network and USB connection ......................... 16
(at the end of this manual)
Information about software ....................................i
3. Playback
Initial Wizard/Easy Setup................................. 18
Setting with the Initial Wizard/Easy Setup................... 18
HOME/MEDIA menu ......................................... 18
Playing back photo/music/video................................... 18
Using network content.................................................. 20
21
21
22
23
Launching Netflix......................................................... 23
Advanced playback operation ........................ 24
24
25
26
26
26
27
27
27
■ About this manual
– This manual describes how to operate this Player
using a remote control except when it is not
available. Some of these operations are also
available using the front panel buttons.
– Notes contain important information about safety
and operating instructions. Hint(s) indicates a tip for
your operation.
– This manual is printed prior to production. Design
and specifications are subject to change in part as a
result of improvements, etc. In case of differences
between the manual and the product, the product has
priority.
The icons used in this manual
Icons are used to indicate available buttons/functions for a
particular format. For details on playable discs and
formats, see page 3.
BD : BD-Video
DVD : DVD-Video, DVD-VR, DVD+VR
CD : Audio CD
VIDEO : Video files
MUSIC : Audio files
PHOTO : Photo files
1 En
English
Connecting to the REMOTE CONTROL jacks ........... 17
Connecting the power cable ......................................... 17
On Screen menu............................................................
Status menu...................................................................
Using Bookmark...........................................................
Program play.................................................................
Using Search ................................................................
Enjoying BONUSVIEW™ and BD-Live™.................
Using Picture in Picture function
(secondary audio/video playback) ...........................
Using the feature of BD-Live™ ...................................
4
Troubleshooting ............................................... 39
Introduction to connections............................ 10
Using network services ...................................
Playing videos from YouTube™ .....................
Playing photos from Picasa™ Web Album....
Playing videos from Netflix™ .........................
3
5
5. Additional information
2. Connection
2
INTRODUCTION
What you can do with this Player
\
p. 18
\
p. 24
\
p. 27
Play back Video, Music, Photo files on a disc/USB memory device* \
p. 18
Easy setting for language, resolution, screen aspect ratio
You can perform language and TV settings.
Play back commercially-released Blu-ray Disc™/Blu-ray 3D™/
DVD/CD discs*
In addition to Blu-ray Discs, this Player also supports playback of a variety of other discs.
Play back BONUSVIEW™, BD-Live™, etc.*
You can enjoy additional movies on the latest Blu-ray Discs.
Files recorded on discs/USB memory devices can be played back with this Player.
Play back Video, Music, Photo files on a Home Network Server* **
\
p. 20
\
p. 31
\
p. 21
PC contents can be played back with TV or AV receiver by connecting this Player to a network
server.
Operation with the remote control of TV, AV receiver, etc.
Connecting devices with an HDMI cable, you can control devices with a single remote control
using the HDMI Control function.
Streaming Playback contents on the Network Services**
You can instantly enjoy videos over the internet with this Player.
* For details on playable discs and formats, see page 3.
** Network setting is needed to use this function.
Supplied parts
Make sure the following accessories are provided with the product.
Remote control
2 En
Batteries (×2)
(AAA, R03, UM-4)
Audio/Video cable
Power cable
1
About discs and files
– 12 cm (5”) and 8 cm (3”) discs can be played back in
this Player. Do not use an 8 cm (3”) to 12 cm (5”)
adapter.
– Use discs that conform to compatible standards as
indicated by the presence of official logos on the
disc label. Playback of discs not complying with
these standards is not guaranteed. In addition, the
image quality or sound quality is not guaranteed
even if the discs can be played back.
Media Type
Recording Format
BD-ROM/BD-R/
BD-RE
BD-Video/Data files
DVD-ROM
DVD-Video
DVD-R/DVD-R
DL/DVD-RW
DVD-Video/DVD-VR/AVCHD/Data files
DVD+R/DVD+R
DL/DVD+RW
DVD-Video/DVD+VR/AVCHD/Data files
CDDA/HDCD
CD-R/CD-RW
CDDA/Data files
USB*
Data files
DLNA
Data files
BD-Video
VIDEO
DivX (.divx)
MKV with DivX
format (.mkv)
MKV with H.264
(.mkv)
MPEG PS (.mpeg/
.mpg)
MPEG TS (.ts)
MPEG-4 (.mp4)
VOB (.vob)
AVI (.avi)
ASF (.asf)
WMV (.wmv)
DVD-Video
Region code “1” or “ALL”
1
ALL
Playable photo
file formats
PHOTO
JPEG (.jpeg/.jpg)
GIF (.gif)
PNG (.png)
Notes
– Playback of a file listed in the chart above is not
guaranteed depending on methods of file creation or
codecs used.
– A copyright protected file cannot be played back.
– When using DLNA, a file needs to meet the DLNA
sever requirement.
– Blu-ray Disc/DVD video operations and functions
may be different from the explanations in this
manual and some operations may be prohibited due
to disc manufacturer’s settings.
– If a menu screen or operating instructions are
displayed during playback of a disc, follow the
operating procedure displayed.
– Playback for some of the discs may not be possible
depending on the disc.
– Finalize all recording media that is played back in
this Player.
– “Finalize” refers to a recorder processing a recorded
disc so that it will play in other players/recorders as
well as this Player. Only finalized discs can be
played back in this Player. (This Player does not
have a function to finalize discs.)
– Playback of all files on the disc, USB memory
device and network is not guaranteed.
– A copyright protected file cannot be played back via
USB memory device and network.
Audio file requirement
– Sampling frequency: within 32 - 48 kHz (MP3/
WMA), LPCM 44.1 kHz/16 bit/Stereo (WAV),
192 kHz/24 bit (FLAC)
– Bitrate: within 8 - 320 kbps (MP3), 32 - 192 kbps
(WMA)
WMV file requirement
– WMV9, maximum resolution is 1,920 × 1,080.
3 En
English
MUSIC
Playable video
file formats
Region code “A” or “ABC”
Notes
* This Player is compatible with a USB memory device
formatted with FAT 16/32 and NTFS.
MP3 (.mp3)
WMA (.wma)
AAC (.aac/.m4a)
WAV (.wav)
FLAC (.flac)
– Blu-ray Disc/DVD video players and discs have
region codes, which dictate the regions in which a
disc can be played. Verify the region code mark on
the rear panel of this Player.
– For a Blu-ray Disc, the disc can be played back on
this Player with the same region code mark, or the
region code “ABC” mark.
– For a DVD disc, the disc can be played back on this
Player with the same region code mark, or the region
code “ALL” mark.
Examples of region codes
CD-ROM
Playable audio
file formats
Region management information for
Blu-ray Disc/DVD videos
Introduction
■ Types of discs/files that can be
used with this Player
About discs and files
■ Loading a disc
– Insert the disc with the label facing up.
– In case of the disc recorded on both sides, face down
the side to play back.
Notes
– Playback may begin automatically, depending on the
disc and setting of this Player.
– The menu may be displayed first, depending on the disc.
– The disc load time may vary depending on the disc.
■ Disc precautions
Be careful of scratches and dust
– Blu-ray Disc, DVD and CD discs are sensitive to dust,
fingerprints and especially scratches. A scratched disc
may not be able to be played back. Handle discs with
care and store them in a safe place.
Proper disc storage
Place the disc in the center of the disc case
and store the case and disc upright.
Avoid storing discs in locations subject to
direct sunlight, close to heating appliances
or in locations of high humidity.
■ Notice for watching 3D video
images
– Some people may experience discomfort (such as
eye strain, fatigue, or nausea) while watching 3D
video images. We recommend that all viewers take
regular breaks while watching 3D video images.
– If you experience any discomfort, stop watching the
3D video images until the discomfort subsides.
Consult a doctor if you experience severe
discomfort.
– Read the owner’s manuals (Blu-ray Disc and TV)
and/or the caution messages that appear on the TV
carefully.
– The vision of young children (especially those under
six years old) is still under development. Consult
your doctor (such as a pediatrician or eye doctor)
before allowing young children to watch 3D video
images.
– Adults should supervise young children to ensure
they follow the recommendations described above.
■ Cinavia technology
– Cinavia technology is a part of the content protection
system included in your Blu-ray Disc Player.
Note
– The following messages may be displayed and
playback stopped or audio outputs temporarily
muted by your Blu-ray Disc player if you are playing
an unauthorized copy of content that is protected by
Cinavia technology.
These messages are displayed in English only.
Do not drop discs or subject them to
strong vibrations or impacts.
Avoid storing discs in locations where
there are large amounts of dust or
moisture.
Handling precautions
– If the surface is soiled, wipe gently with a
soft, damp (water only) cloth. When
wiping discs, always move the cloth from
the center hole toward the outer edge.
– Do not use record cleaning sprays,
benzene, thinner, static electricity
prevention liquids or any other solvent.
– Do not touch the surface.
– Do not stick paper or adhesive labels to the disc.
– If the playing surface of a disc is soiled or scratched,
the Player may decide that the disc is incompatible
and eject the disc tray, or it may fail to play the disc
correctly. Wipe any dirt off the playing surface with
a soft cloth.
Cleaning the pick up lens
– Never use commercially available cleaning discs.
The use of these discs can damage the lens.
– Request the nearest service center approved by
Yamaha to clean the lens.
4 En
Playback stopped. The content being played is
protected by Cinavia™ and is not authorized
for playback on this device.
For more information, see http://www.cinavia.com.
Message Code 1.
Audio outputs temporarily muted. Do not adjust
the playback volume. The content being played
is protected by Cinavia™ and is not authorized
for playback on this device.
For more information, see http://www.cinavia.com.
Message Code 3.
Cinavia Notice
This product uses Cinavia technology to limit the use of
unauthorized copies of some commercially-produced film
and videos and their soundtracks. When a prohibited use
of an unauthorized copy is detected, a message will be
displayed and playback or copying will be interrupted.
More information about Cinavia technology is provided at
the Cinavia Online Consumer Information Center at
http://www.cinavia.com. To request additional
information about Cinavia by mail, send a postcard with
your mailing address to: Cinavia Consumer Information
Center, P.O. Box 86851, San Diego, CA, 92138, USA.
1
Controls and functions
Introduction
■ Front panel
USB
1 2
3
1 p (On/Standby)
Turns this Player on/Sets to standby mode.
Press and hold p on the front panel for more than 5
seconds, and release to reset this Player (system reset).
2 USB connector (p. 16)
3 Front panel display
Displays various information for operational status.
4
5 6 7
(Eject)
Opens/Closes the disc tray.
9
0
(Search backward/Skip backward):
Press to skip backward, and press and hold to search
backward.
7
(Search forward/Skip forward):
Press to skip forward, and press and hold to search
forward.
8
(Play)
Starts a playback.
9
(Pause)
Pauses a playback.
0
(Stop)
Stops a playback.
English
6
4 Disc tray door
5
8
Note
– A factory-fitted protective film covers the front panel of this Player. Remove the protective film from the Player
before operating it.
5 En
Controls and functions
■ Remote control
1 Infrared signal transmitter: Outputs infrared
signal. Aim this window to the remote control sensor
(p. 9).
Note
–
will appear on the top left corner of the screen
when the pressed button is not available.
1
2
3
4
PROGRAM
MARKER
DIGEST
ZOOM
R
G
Y
B
SUBTITLE
ANGLE
5
6
7
8
9
0
AUDIO
CLEAR
SEARCH
PIP
SETUP
2ND
AUDIO
HOME
TOP MENU
SHUFFLE
REPEAT
A B
POP-UP MENU
2 MARKER DVD VIDEO : Sets Bookmark (p. 26) at
a specified point of a movie. After Bookmark is set, to
select the set point you want to jump to, press
DIGEST. You can set up to 12 Bookmarks.
C
3
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
4 PROGRAM DVD CD : Sets the order of playback
(p. 26). You can set up to 15 tracks (for an audio disc)
or titles/chapters (DVD-Video).
L
6 CLEAR: Clears entered number/set item.
M
7 PIP BD : Turns on/off the Picture in Picture (p. 27).
: Opens/closes the disc tray.
5 Number buttons: Enters numbers, or during
playback, jumps to the track/chapter corresponding to
the number you input. These buttons may not be
available depending on the disc type and playback
condition.
PIP Mark (
) is displayed on the screen when this
function is available. You can also select this item from
On Screen menu (p. 24).
ENTER
Note
RETURN
ON SCREEN
– PIP Mark is displayed only when the PIP Mark is set
to on (p. 32).
8 SETUP: Displays SETUP menu screen (p. 28).
A
B
NETFLIX
STATUS
9 2ND AUDIO BD : Selects the secondary audio of the
Picture in Picture (p. 27) or audio commentaries. The
Secondary Audio Mark (
) is displayed on the
screen when this function is available (p. 35). You can
also select this item from On Screen menu (p. 24).
Note
– Secondary Audio Mark is displayed only when
Secondary Audio Mark is set to on (p. 32).
0 HOME: Displays the HOME menu screen (p. 18).
A NETFLIX: Starts Netflix (p. 23).
B STATUS: Displays the playback information (p. 25).
C DIGEST PHOTO : Shows 12 photo thumbnails.
When thumbnails are displayed, you can proceed to
the next/previous page with
/
.
DVD
VIDEO : Displays Bookmark select bar
(p. 26).
D p: Turns this Player on or sets it to standby mode.
E ZOOM DVD VIDEO PHOTO : Zooms in/out.
The size of the screen will change each time you press
the button (zoom in/out: 3 steps each).
F Color buttons BD : Use these buttons according to
on-screen instructions.
6 En
Controls and functions
G SUBTITLE BD DVD VIDEO : Changes subtitle
languages (p. 43) if available. You can also select this
item from On Screen menu (p. 24).
1
Introduction
H ANGLE BD DVD : Changes the camera angle if
video is recorded with multiple angles. The Angle
Mark (
) is displayed on the screen when this
function is available. You can also select this item
from On Screen menu (p. 24).
Note
– Angle Mark is displayed only when the Angle Mark
is set to on (p. 32).
I AUDIO BD DVD : Changes the audio language or
format. You can also select this item from On Screen
menu (p. 24).
J SEARCH BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC :
Jumps to a specified point during playback. For details
on this function, refer to “Using Search” (p. 26). You
can also select this item from status menu (p. 25).
K SHUFFLE DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO : Selects shuffle play mode (p. 24).
L REPEAT BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO : Changes repeat mode. Repeat mode shown
below will change each time you press the button.
English
: Repeats the title being played back.
: Repeats the chapter being played back.
: Repeats the folder being played back.
: Repeats all tracks/files on the disc.
: Repeats the track/file being played back.
M A/B BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC : Plays back
a specific part you want to repeat.
1 Press A/B at the scene where you want to set the
start point. “A-” is displayed on the screen.
2 Press A/B again at the scene where you want to set
the end point. “A-B” is displayed on the screen.
Repeat playback starts.
3 To cancel the repeat playback, press A/B. “A-B”
disappears and the repeat playback is finished.
Note
– This function cannot be performed depending on the
specifications of the disc.
Continued to the next page. \
7 En
Controls and functions
N TOP MENU BD DVD : Displays the top menu
screen if the disc contains a menu. Select the desired
item using 5/a/2/3 and ENTER.
PROGRAM
MARKER
DIGEST
ZOOM
R
G
Y
B
Note
– Specific operations may be different depending on
the disc. Follow the instructions of each menu
screen.
SUBTITLE
ANGLE
O Cursor buttons (5/a/2/3): Moves the focus in
the menu screen.
ENTER: Selects the focused menu/item.
AUDIO
CLEAR
SEARCH
SHUFFLE
PIP
SETUP
REPEAT
2ND
AUDIO
HOME
A B
TOP MENU
POP-UP MENU
N
O
P
P RETURN: Returns to the previous menu or screen,
etc.
R
ENTER
RETURN
ON SCREEN
S
Q
Q Control buttons
BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO
: Stops playback. To stop playback completely,
press this button twice.
: Pauses playback.
: Plays back contents.
/
DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC :
Searches backward/forward. The search speed will
change each time you press the button (search
backward/forward: 5 steps each). Press
to resume
normal playback.
BD
NETFLIX
STATUS
PHOTO : Changes the speed of a slide show (slower/
faster: 3 steps).
/
DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC :
Press for instant search/replay. Instant search skips the
content 30 seconds. Instant replay replays the content
from 10 seconds before.
BD
/
: Skips backward/forward.
Note
– Depending on the disc, this Player resumes playback
from the point that where the Player was previously
stopped. To play back from the beginning, press
twice and then
.
R POP-UP/MENU BD DVD : Displays pop-up
menu. The menu contents displayed vary depending
on the disc. For details on how to see and operate the
pop-up menu, refer to the manual for the disc.
The top menu screen may be displayed by pressing
POP-UP/MENU depending on the DVD.
S ON SCREEN: Displays On Screen menu (p. 24).
8 En
Controls and functions
ID function
Loading the batteries in the remote
control
1
1 Remote control setting
To change the ID from ID1 to ID2, press and hold
the red color button and 2 of number button
simultaneously for 7 seconds. To change the ID
from ID2 to ID1, press and hold the red color button
and 1 of number button simultaneously for 7
seconds.
2 Main unit setting
Press and hold
and
on the
front panel simultaneously for 2 seconds to display
current ID when:
– No disc is inserted in this Player.
– The disc tray is closed.
– Playback is stopped.
– “NO DISC” is displayed on the front panel
display.
Keep pressing and holding the keys for another 2
seconds to change the ID between ID1 and ID2.
Notes
3
2
Notes
– Change both batteries when the operation range of
the remote control decreases.
– Use AAA, R03, UM-4 batteries.
– Make sure that the polarities are correct. Refer to the
illustration inside the battery compartment.
– Remove the batteries if the remote control is not to
be used for an extended period of time.
– Do not use old batteries together with new ones.
– Do not use different types of batteries (such as
alkaline and manganese batteries) together. Read the
packaging carefully as these different types of
batteries may have the same shape and color.
– If the batteries have leaked, dispose of them
immediately. Avoid touching the leaked material or
letting it come into contact with clothing, etc. Clean
the battery compartment thoroughly before installing
new batteries.
– Do not throw away batteries with general house
waste; dispose of them correctly in accordance with
your local regulations.
– Keep batteries away from children. If a battery is
accidentally swallowed, contact your doctor
immediately.
– When not planning to use the remote control for long
periods of time, remove the batteries from the
remote control.
– Do not charge or disassemble the supplied batteries.
Approximate operating range of
remote control
Remote control sensor
USB
30°
30°
6 m (20 ft)
9 En
English
– If the remote control is without batteries for a few
minutes or if exhausted batteries remain in the
remote control, the remote control ID is
automatically set to ID1. If you want to use the
remote control in ID2 setting, install new batteries
and set the remote control ID again.
– When this Player is reset, its remote control ID will
be ID1.
1
Introduction
You can change the remote control ID to prevent
unwanted operation of the other Yamaha player such as
DVD player. If you have changed the remote control ID,
make sure that you select the same ID for the main unit.
The default setting is ID1.
CONNECTION
Introduction to connections
Find the corresponding connection method on your video/audio equipment. We recommend that you use the HDMI
terminal which provides high quality digital audio and video on a single connection. If you use the other terminals/jacks,
connect the video first. Then connect the audio.
Connect video and audio to AV
receiver with an HDMI cable.
HDMI terminal on
AV receiver? *
HDMI terminal on TV?
Refer to owner’s manual
of AV receiver.
HDMI terminal on TV?
START
Connect video to TV with an HDMI cable.
Use AV receiver?
Connect video to AV receiver.
HDMI terminal on TV?
Connect video and audio to TV with an HDMI cable.
Connect video to TV.
Yes
* When you connect to an AV receiver that cannot output the sound,
input via its HDMI terminal, refer to the owner’s manual of your AV
receiver.
No
■ Rear panel
0
9
AC IN
VIDEO OUT
Y
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
AUDIO OUT
L
R
OUT
IN
REMOTE CONTROL
VIDEO
PR
COMPONENT
1 2 3
10 En
OPTICAL
4
USB
5
6
7
8
2
Connection
Video and audio connection to
AV receiver
A HDMI (p. 12)
Audio connection to AV receiver
Video connection
to TV
A’ HDMI (p. 12)
Connect audio to AV
receiver.
D COAXIAL (p. 14)
or
to AV receiver
E
OPTICAL (p. 14)
B COMPONENT (p. 13)
or
or
F L/R (p. 15)
C VIDEO (p. 13)
Video and audio connection to TV
A’ HDMI (p. 12)
English
Audio connection to TV
Video connection to TV
Connect audio to TV.
D’ COAXIAL (p. 14)
or
B’ COMPONENT (p. 13)
E’ OPTICAL (p. 14)
or
or
C’ VIDEO (p. 13)
F’ L/R (p. 15)
1 VIDEO (p. 13)
6 AUDIO OUT (L/R) (p. 15)
2 COMPONENT (p. 13)
7 REMOTE CONTROL (OUT/IN) (p. 17)
3 HDMI (p. 12)
8 AC IN (p. 17)
4 OPTICAL (p. 14)
9 NETWORK (p. 16)
5 USB (p. 16)
0 COAXIAL (p. 14)
11 En
HDMI connection
■ Connecting to the HDMI terminal
–
–
–
–
You can enjoy high quality digital picture and sound through the HDMI terminal.
Firmly connect an HDMI cable (commercially available) to the HDMI terminals.
See page 36 for information on the audio/video output formats.
Use HIGH SPEED HDMI cables that have the HDMI logo (as shown on the back cover).
Caution!
Do not connect the power cable of this Player until all connections are completed.
This Player
VIDEO OUT
Y
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
VIDEO
PR
COMPONENT
OPTICAL
USB
Hints
– When you use the HDMI Control function,
refer to the “HDMI Control” (p. 31).
– For information on the output mode of HDMI
terminal, refer to the “HDMI” (p. 35).
– When no picture is displayed, refer to
“Troubleshooting” (p. 40).
To HDMI terminal
■ Connection for the playback
of Blu-ray 3D Discs
HDMI cable
(commercially available)
To enjoy Blu-ray 3D Discs on this Player, you need
the following equipment and connections:
– You need a TV and an AV receiver (if you
need) that have 3D functionality.
– All the components must be connected with
HDMI cables.
– A Blu-ray Disc should contain 3D images.
– You need to set 3D Output in Display Setting
A’
(p. 33) to Auto.
A
To HDMI input terminal
HDMI IN
AV receiver
12 En
TV
Video connections
■ Connecting to the component/video jack
Caution!
2
Connection
– You can enjoy accurate color reproduction and high quality images through the component jacks.
– Firmly connect a component video cable (commercially available) or a video pin cable to the COMPONENT jacks/
VIDEO jack.
– See page 37 for information on the video output formats.
Do not connect the power cable of this Player until all connections are completed.
This Player
VIDEO OUT
Y
This Player
VIDEO OUT
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
Y
HDMI
PB
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
NETWORK
PR
VIDEO
COMPONENT
(Green)
(Red)
(Blue)
OPTICAL
PR
VIDEO
COMPONENT
USB
OPTICAL
To COMPONENT
jacks
USB
(Yellow)
To VIDEO
jack
B
B’
Audio/Video cable
(supplied)
C
C’
To video
input jack
To component
input jacks
COMPONENT IN
(Yellow)
(Yellow)
Y
(Green)
(Green)
(Yellow)
PB
(Blue)
(Blue)
PR
(Red)
(Green)
(Blue)
(Red)
(Red)
VIDEO
AV INPUT
AV receiver
TV
AV receiver
TV
Notes
– If you play back the image via VCR, the image may deteriorate due to the copy guard function.
– To enjoy Blu-ray 3D discs on this Player, you need to connect an AV receiver, a TV, and this Player using HDMI
cables. See page 12.
13 En
English
Component video cable
(commercially available)
Audio connections
■ Connecting to the digital audio jack/terminal
– You can connect audio equipment or the TV to the COAXIAL jack/OPTICAL terminal.
– Firmly connect a Coaxial digital audio cable (commercially available) or optical cable (commercially available) to
the coaxial digital audio jack or optical digital audio terminal.
– See page 36 for information on the audio output formats.
Caution!
Do not connect the power cable of this Player until all connections are completed.
This Player
This Player
VIDEO OUT
Y
PB
VIDEO OUT
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
Y
HDMI
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
NETWORK
AUDIO OUT
L
R
PR
VIDEO
COMPONENT
OPTICAL
PR
VIDEO
COMPONENT
USB
OPTICAL
USB
To COAXIAL
jack
To OPTICAL
terminal
Coaxial digital audio cable
(commercially available)
D
D’
Optical cable
(commercially available)
E
To coaxial
input jack
AV receiver
E’
To optical
input terminal
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
AV INPUT
DIGITAL AUDIO IN
TV
AV receiver
TV
Hint
– For information on the output mode of COAXIAL jack/OPTICAL terminal, refer to the “Coaxial / Optical” (p. 35).
14 En
Audio connections
■ Connecting to the audio jacks
– You can connect audio equipment or the TV to the AUDIO OUT L/R jacks.
– Firmly connect an Audio/Video cable (supplied) to the AUDIO OUT L/R jack.
– See page 36 for information on the audio output formats.
2
Caution!
Connection
Do not connect the power cable of this Player until all connections are completed.
This Player
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
DMI
NETWORK
AUDIO OUT
OUT
L
R
IN
REMOTE CONTROL
USB
(Red)
To AUDIO OUT
L/R jack
(White)
OPTICAL
Audio/Video cable
(supplied)
English
F
F’
To audio L/R
input jack
(White) (Red)
AV receiver
R
AUDIO IN
(Red)
L
(White)
(Red)
(White)
AUDIO
TV
15 En
Network and USB connection
■ Connecting to the NETWORK terminal
– PC contents can be played back by connecting this Player to the network.
– You can enjoy a variety of contents with interactive functions by connecting to the internet when playing BD-Live
compatible discs. Refer to page 27 regarding further information on BD-Live functions.
Notes
–
–
–
–
–
Firmly connect a network cable (commercially available) to the NETWORK terminal.
Use only an STP (shielded twisted pair) network cable.
When using the internet, a broadband internet connection as shown below is required.
Connect the other connector of the network cable to the hub/broadband router.
When using a broadband internet connection, a contract with an internet service provider is required. For more
details, contact your nearest internet service provider.
– Refer to the operation manual of the equipment you have as the connected equipment and connection method may
differ depending on your internet environment.
– Use a network cable/router supporting 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX.
■ Connecting to the USB connector
– You can connect a USB memory device for Local Storage to the USB connector on the rear panel (or front panel) of
this Player to save the BD-Live data, or to upgrade the software of this Player.
– Firmly connect a USB memory device (commercially available) to the USB connector.
CAUTION:
– Do not remove the USB memory device or
unplug the power cable while the operations for
BD-Live (p. 27) or software upgrade are being
performed.
– Do not use a USB extension cable when
connecting a USB memory device to the USB
connector of this Player. Using a USB
extension cable may prevent the Player from
performing correctly.
This Player
VIDEO OUT
Y
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
AUDIO OUT
L
R
VIDEO
PR
COMPONENT
OPTICAL
USB
Note
– Yamaha cannot guarantee that all brands’ USB
memory devices will operate with this Player.
To USB
connector
To NETWORK
terminal
USB memory device
(commercially available)
Network cable
(commercially available)
Hint
– To save BD-Live data on
the USB memory device
on the front panel, set
Local Storage to Front
USB (p. 31).
To LAN
terminal
LAN
Internet
Modem
Hub or
broadband router
After connecting
– When you set the Network setting manually, refer to “Network” (p. 32).
– To play back the PC contents on your network, refer to “Using network content” (p. 20).
16 En
PC
Other connections
■ Connecting to the REMOTE
CONTROL jacks
Caution!
– For details about the SCENE function, refer to the
owner’s manual supplied with your Yamaha AV
receiver.
– You can connect a Yamaha component (such as CD
player) supports the SCENE function to the
REMOTE CONTROL (OUT) jack of this Player.
2
Connection
– You can transmit and receive the remote control
signals by connecting to the REMOTE CONTROL
(OUT/IN) jacks.
– Firmly connect monaural 3.5 mm mini plug cables
(commercially available) to the REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT/IN) jacks.
– If your AV receiver is a Yamaha product and has the
capability to transmit SCENE control signals, you
can control the Player with the SCENE function.
Hints
■ Connecting the power cable
– After all connections are completed, plug the
supplied power cable into the AC IN on the rear of
the Player. Then plug into AC outlet.
Do not connect the power cable of this
Player until all connections are completed.
AC IN
This Player
RK
AUDIO OUT
L
R
OUT
IN
REMOTE CONTROL
To AC inlet
Monaural 3.5 mm
mini plug cable
(commercially
available)
To REMOTE
CONTROL (IN)
jack
Monaural 3.5 mm mini
plug cable
(commercially available)
To AC outlet
English
To REMOTE
CONTROL
(OUT) jack
Note
– TO PREVENT RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO
NOT TOUCH THE UN-INSULATED PARTS OF
ANY CABLES WHILE THE POWER CABLE IS
CONNECTED.
To remote
control out
jack
To remote
control in
jack
REMOTE CONTROL IN
Yamaha component
REMOTE CONTROL OUT
Infrared signal receiver
or Yamaha component
(such as AV receiver)
17 En
PLAYBACK
Initial Wizard/Easy Setup
■ Setting with the Initial Wizard/Easy Setup
Initial Wizard/Easy Setup allows you to set language, resolution, and screen aspect ratio easily. Initial Wizard screen is
displayed when you turn this Player on for the first time after purchase. Same setting can be performed from SETUP
menu = System = Easy Setup.
1 When Easy Setup screen is displayed, press ENTER to
start Easy Setup.
2 Set the language, resolution, and screen aspect ration
by following the on-screen messages.
Notes
– When no picture is displayed after Initial Wizard/
Easy Setup is completed, refer to “Troubleshooting”
(p. 40).
– A warning message concerning 3D video playback
appears when this Player is turned on. Press ENTER
to dismiss the message or CLEAR to disable it
(p. 31).
HOME/MEDIA menu
HOME and MEDIA menus allow you to browse and play multi-media files on data discs, USB memory devices and your
network.
Note
Icons on the top of MEDIA menu
– For details on playable discs and formats, see page 3.
: Plays back the disc on the tray, or displays contents
in the data disc.
: Displays contents in the USB memory device
connected to the USB connector.
: Searches for a DLNA (p. 20) server on the network.
: Displays contents on the connected DLNA server.
■ Playing back photo/music/video
Basic operation
2/3/5/a: Moves the focus.
2: Returns to the parent folder.
HOME: Moves to/exits HOME menu screen.
ENTER: Confirms the folder/file.
PIP
SETUP
2ND
AUDIO
HOME
TOP MENU
REPEAT
A B
POP-UP MENU
ENTER
RETURN
18 En
ON SCREEN
HOME/MEDIA menu
Common operations for playing back
files in a selected folder
4 Select the Photo, Music, Video or AVCHD folder you
want to play back, then press ENTER.
To return to the parent folder, press 2 or select
.
Example: Selecting a movie file on a USB memory
device
Note
– Stop the playback of the video before you move to
MEDIA menu screen.
3
Playback
1 Press HOME to move to HOME menu screen.
Note
– Note that the only the file type selected on this step
will be displayed in the following step. For example,
if you selected Photo folder in this step, only photo
files are displayed after this step. When you want to
play back other than photo, return to this step and
select file type again.
Hint
– The HOME menu screen may differ depending on
the model.
5 Select the folder(s) containing the file you want to play
back.
2 Press 2/3/5/a to select MEDIA, then press ENTER.
MEDIA screen appears.
English
3 Select the item which contains the file you want to play
back, then press ENTER.
Continued to the next page. \
19 En
HOME/MEDIA menu
6 Select the file you want to play back, then press
ENTER.
When a video file is selected, playback starts.
When a music file is selected, status screen is displayed
and playback starts.
When a photo file is selected, slide show starts.
■ Using network content
This Player is DLNA certified (p. 42). You can manage
photo, music and video contents stored on DLNA servers
on your home network.
Playing back shared contents
1 To play back files on your PC, install a DLNA server
software, such as Windows Media Player 12, and share
files you want to play back.
2 Turn on the PC with DLNA server software installed or
the DLNA device connected to your home network.
3 Press HOME to display HOME menu screen. Then
select MEDIA to move to MEDIA menu. The DLNA
servers connected to the network are listed on the
screen.
Hint
– To enjoy slide show with music, press HOME to
return to the HOME menu screen while music is
played back, and select photo file.
Note
– The displayed file may not be played back
depending on the content.
Operations for viewing photos
While viewing photos, the buttons on the remote control
work as shown below.
: Stops slide show and returns to the file browser.
: Pauses a slide show.
: Plays a slide show.
: Moves to a next photo.
: Moves to a previous photo.
: Makes a slide show faster in 3 steps.
: Makes a slide show slower in 3 steps.
5: Inverts a photo.
a: Reflects a photo.
2: Rotates a photo counterclockwise.
3: Rotates a photo clockwise.
ZOOM: Zooms in/out a photo (zoom in/out: 3 steps each).
5/a/2/3: Pans in zoom mode when a photo is larger
than the screen.
DIGEST: Switches to thumbnail mode (p. 6). When
thumbnails are displayed, you can proceed to the next/
previous page with
/
.
20 En
Notes
– If your DLNA server is not listed, select DLNA
Search to find it.
– Depending on the DLNA server, this Player may
need to be permitted from the server.
– To play the file on the DLNA server, this Player and
the server must be connected to the same access
point.
– The file requirements may not always be compatible.
There may be some restrictions depending on file
features and DLNA sever capability.
4 Select the file you want to play back.
Notes
– The playback and operating quality may be affected
by your home network condition.
– The files from removable media such as USB
memory devices or DVD-drive on your media
server, may not be shared properly.
Using network services
You can instantly watch the videos that the following network services provide.
– YouTube
– Picasa (p. 22)
– Netflix (p. 23)
3
Notes
Playback
– Access to content provided by third parties requires a high speed internet connection and may also require account
registration and a paid subscription.
– Third party content services may be changed, suspended, interrupted, or discontinued at any time without notice,
and Yamaha disclaims any liability in connection with such occurrences.
– Some content may only be available for specific countries and may be presented in specific languages.
– Yamaha does not represent or warrant that content services will continue to be provided or available for a particular
period of time, and any such warranty, express or implied, is disclaimed.
Playing videos from YouTube™
You can watch movies from YouTube over the internet using this Player.
The services may be changed without notice.
1 Press HOME to display HOME menu screen.
English
Hint
– The HOME menu screen may differ depending on
the model.
2 Press 2/3/5/a to select YouTube, then press
ENTER.
Hint
– To exit from YouTube, press RETURN.
21 En
Playing photos from Picasa™ Web Album
You can watch photos from Picasa Web Album over the internet using this Player.
The service may be changed without notice.
1 Register your user name and password on the computer
before you use Picasa Web Album.
2 Press HOME to display HOME menu screen.
Press 2/3/5/a to select Picasa, then press ENTER.
Hint
– The HOME menu screen may differ depending on
the model.
3 When you access Picasa from this Player for the first
time, select the New User icon and enter your
registered user name and password.
Hint
– To exit from Picasa, press RETURN.
22 En
Playing videos from Netflix™
You can instantly watch movies and TV episodes from Netflix over the internet using this Player. To become a Netflix
member, visit www.netflix.com .
Netflix is available in certain countries. Unlimited membership required.
More information at www.netflix.com
3
■ Launching Netflix
Playback
1 Press HOME to display HOME menu screen.
Press 2/3/5/a to select NETFLIX, then press
ENTER.
You can also press NETFLIX on the remote control to
launch Netflix.
Hints
English
– The HOME menu screen may differ depending on
the model.
– To return to the HOME menu screen, press
RETURN.
Notes
– When a software upgrade is required, an update
notice appears when you select Netflix. In this case,
perform the software upgrade.
– For details on Netflix, refer to the Netflix website on
www.netflix.com .
– To deactivate Netflix, refer to “Netflix Information”
(p. 32).
23 En
Advanced playback operation
This chapter explains playback of commercially available
Blu-ray Discs, DVDs, CDs, and recorded DVD-RW/R
discs.
Note
– For the basic playback operation, see page 6.
■ On Screen menu
To display On Screen menu, press ON SCREEN. After
that, press 5/a/2/3 to select an item, then press ENTER
to operate the desired function.
DVD
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Normal
Shuffle CH (chapter)
Shuffle TT (title)
Shuffle All
Random CH (chapter)
Random TT (title)
Random All
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO
– Normal
– Shuffle F (folder)
– Random F (folder)
Audio BD DVD VIDEO : Shows audio language/
signal of a Blu-ray Disc/DVD currently selected. You can
select the desired type of audio.
Angle BD DVD : Shows the currently-selected angle
number. If the video is recorded with multiple angles, you
can change the angle.
Subtitle BD DVD VIDEO : Shows the currentlyselected subtitle language when the subtitle is provided.
On Screen menu contains following items.
Title BD DVD VIDEO : Shows the title number being
played back. You can skip to the desired title by selecting
it from this item.
Chapter BD DVD VIDEO : Shows the chapter
number being played back. You can skip to the desired
chapter by selecting it from this item.
Track/File CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO : Shows
track/file number being played back. You can skip to the
desired track/file by selecting it from this item.
Time BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC : Shows the
playback time. Select display type from the following:
– Elapsed playback time of the title, chapter, disc,
track or file
– Remaining playback time of the title, chapter, disc,
track or file
Mode/Play Mode
DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO : Shows current
playback mode. You can select playback mode from the
following:
Subtitle Style BD : Shows the currently-selected
subtitle style. This function is available only for Video-file
external subtitle. You can select the desired text style of
subtitle.
Bitrate BD DVD CD VIDEO
bitrate of the audio/video signal.
MUSIC : Shows
Second Video BD : Turns the PIP on/off (p. 6).
Second Audio BD : Turns the secondary audio on/off
(p. 6).
Ins Search
BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC : Skips 30 seconds.
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC : Replays the content
Ins Replay
BD
DVD
from 10 seconds before.
Slide Show PHOTO :
Shows slide show speed. You can select the slide show
speed from Slow/Medium/Fast.
Transition PHOTO : Shows how photo appears on the
screen. You can select the transition type.
CD
– Normal: Normal playback.
– Shuffle: Random playback without repetition.
– Random: Random playback with repetition.
24 En
Code Page VIDEO : Selects character code of subtitle
you added to DivX video (p. 42).
Advanced playback operation
■ Status menu
This shows various settings, such as subtitles, angle
settings and the title/chapter/track number currently
played back. To display status menu, press STATUS.
Status menu contains following menus.
BD
DVD
CD
MUSIC
Example: Icons when playing a music file
VIDEO
Example: Icons when playing a Blu-ray Disc
2
1
3
4
3
5
Playback
8 7
1
2
3
4
6
(Playback status)
(Disc type/video file icon)
(Title number being played): You can jump to
specified title with SEARCH button (p. 7).
(Chapter number being played): You can
jump to specified chapter with SEARCH button (p. 7).
(Elapsed playback time): You can jump to
specified point with SEARCH button (p. 7).
(Subtitle currently selected): You can change
the subtitle language with SUBTITLE button.
7
(Audio currently selected): You can change the
audio language or format with AUDIO button.
8
(Repeat mode): Shows current repeat mode (p. 7).
1
(Playback status)
2
(Repeat mode): Shows current repeat mode (p. 7).
3
(Disc type/music file icon)
4 (Artwork) MUSIC : Displays artwork if the file
contains it.
5
(Track/file number being played): You can
jump to specified track with SEARCH button (p. 7).
6 (Information) MUSIC : Displays music information
if the file contains them.
7
(Elapsed playback time): You can jump to
specified point with SEARCH button (p. 7).
8 (Progress bar) MUSIC : Shows progress status of
current song.
PHOTO
1
(Playback status)
2
(Photo file icon)
3
(File number being displayed)
4
(Repeat mode): Shows current repeat mode (p. 7).
5 (Slide show speed)
25 En
English
5
6
Advanced playback operation
■ Using Bookmark
DVD
VIDEO
This allows you to set Bookmark at the specified point of
the video. After Bookmark is set, you can move to the
point you set using this function. You can set up to 12
Bookmarks.
1 Press MARKER during playing back the movie to set
Bookmark. Bookmark number, and the status are
displayed.
2 Press ENTER to program playback order.
For audio disc, press 5/a to select a desired track then
press ENTER.
For DVD-Video disc, select a desired title (shown as
TT) and chapter (shown as CH) instead of a track.
To clear a set track, select the track you want to clear,
then press CLEAR.
Press RETURN to cancel the Program play.
2 After Bookmark is set, press DIGEST to display
Bookmark select bar.
3 Press 2/3 to select the Bookmark you want to play
back, then press ENTER.
Press CLEAR to delete the selected Bookmark.
Note
– When playback is finished (e.g., ejecting the disc,
pressing
twice), Bookmarks are automatically
deleted.
■ Program play
DVD
CD
3 After programming is finished, press
start program playback.
to set and
4 To cancel program play, stop playback completely by
pressing
twice.
■ Using Search
BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO
This allows you to program playback order of audio disc
tracks or DVD chapters.
Press PROGRAM during playback to display the
PROGRAM window to program playback order.
You can program up to 15 tracks/chapters.
This allows you to jump to the specified point during
playback.
Example: Programming the playback order of CD tracks
2 Press 5/a/2/3 to select one of the item below, then
press ENTER.
1 Press PROGRAM during playback.
1 Press SEARCH during playback. Status bar appears.
BD DVD :
– Title number (shown as
)
– Chapter number (shown as
)
– Elapsed title time (shown as
)
– Elapsed chapter time (shown as
)
CD :
– Track number (shown as
)
– Elapsed track time (shown as
)
– Elapsed disc time (shown as
VIDEO
)
MUSIC :
– File number (shown as
)
– Elapsed file time (shown as
)
PHOTO :
– File number (shown as
)
3 Press 5/a or number buttons to set/adjust the value of
the focused item, and press ENTER to jump to the
specified point.
4 To close the status bar, press STATUS.
26 En
Advanced playback operation
■ Enjoying BONUSVIEW™ and BDLive™
■ Using the feature of BD-Live™
This Player supports BONUSVIEW (p. 42) (BD-ROM
Profile 1 Version 1.1) and BD-Live (p. 42) (BD-ROM
Profile 2) playback functions.
1. Set the Network setting (p. 32).
Note
■ Using Picture in Picture function
(secondary audio/video playback)
BD-Video that includes secondary audio and video
compatible with Picture in Picture can be played back
with secondary audio and video simultaneously as a small
video in the corner.
Primary video
Secondary video
BD-Live data is saved in a USB memory device
connected to this Player. To enjoy these functions,
connect a USB memory device supporting USB 2.0
High Speed (480 Mbit/s) to the USB connector that
you select on Local Storage (p. 31). The default
setting is the USB connector on the rear panel.
– BUDA folder is created automatically in the USB
memory device when necessary.
– If there is insufficient storage space, the data will not
be copied/downloaded. Delete unneeded data or use
a new USB memory device.
– Some time may be required for the data to load
(read/write).
3
Playback
– Functions and playback method vary depending on
the disc. See the guidance on the disc or the supplied
user’s manual.
2. Connect the USB memory device
to this Player (p. 16).
Notes
Notes
– To listen to secondary audio, make sure that the
Audio Output setting (Coaxial / Optical or HDMI) is
set to PCM or Reencode (p. 35).
– Depending on the disc, to listen to secondary audio,
you may need to set secondary audio to on from the
top menu of the disc (p. 8).
– The secondary audio and video for Picture in Picture
may automatically play back and be removed
depending on the content. Also, playable areas may
be restricted.
3. Play back the disc.
English
While PIP Mark (
) or Secondary
Audio Mark (
) is displayed, press
PIP to turn the Picture in Picture
function on/off.
– Yamaha cannot guarantee that all brands’ USB
memory devices will operate with this Player.
– Do not use a USB extension cable when connecting
a USB memory device to the USB connector of the
Player. Using a USB extension cable may prevent
the Player from performing correctly.
4. Run BD-Live according to the
instructions on the disc.
Notes
– Regarding playback method of BD-Live contents,
etc., perform the operations in accordance with the
instructions in the Blu-ray Disc manual.
– To enjoy BD-Live functions, perform the network
connection (p. 16) and Network settings (p. 32).
– Refer to “BD-Live Connection” (p. 33) regarding the
setup to restrict access to BD-Live contents.
– The time required to download the provided
programs into the USB memory device connected to
this Player varies depending on the internet
connection speeds and the data volume of the
programs.
– BD-Live programs provided through the internet
may not be able to display the connection depending
on the status (upgrading) of the provider. In such
cases, take out the disc and try again.
– If the BD-Live screen does not appear for a while
after you select the BD-Live function in the Blu-ray
Disc menu, the USB memory device may not have
enough free space. In such cases, eject the disc from
the Player, and then erase the data in the USB
memory device using the “Format” menu in the
“Local Storage” (p. 31).
27 En
SETTINGS
SETUP menu
The SETUP menu enables various audio/visual settings and adjustments for functions using the remote control unit.
Menu/Submenu
Item
System
Screen Saver
Sets screen saver on/off.
31
Disc Auto Playback
Sets this Player to start disc playback automatically.
31
HDMI Control
Sets this Player to receive control signal from the remote
control of your TV/AV receiver.
31
Network Control
Sets the control via Ethernet to on/off.
31
Load Default
Resets all settings to the default setting except Security
setting.
31
General Setting
Playback
Security
Network
28 En
Page
Upgrade
Performs upgrade of this Player.
31
Easy Setup
Sets language, resolution, screen aspect ratio.
31
Local Storage
Displays status of Local Storage (p. 31), formats Local
Storage and selects the front/rear USB connector for Local
Storage.
31
Displays a warning message concerning 3D video playback
when this Player is turned on.
31
OSD
Selects the language for On Screen Display.
31
Menu
Prioritizes the language for disc menu.
31
Audio
Prioritizes the language for audio.
32
Subtitle
Prioritizes the language for subtitle.
32
Closed Caption
Sets the closed caption to on/off.
32
Angle Mark
Sets to display the Angle Mark when Blu-ray Disc/DVD with
multiple angles is played back.
32
PIP Mark
Sets to display the PIP Mark when Blu-ray Disc/DVD with
Picture in Picture is played back.
32
Secondary Audio
Mark
Sets to display the Secondary Audio Mark when Blu-ray
Disc/DVD with secondary audio is played back.
32
Last Memory
Sets this Player to remember the last playback position of a
disc when it is set to standby mode or the disc tray is opened.
32
DivX(R) VOD
DRM
Displays registration code for DivX(R) video.
Netflix Information
Deactivates this Player from Netflix and displays ESN
(Electronic Serial Number).
32
Change Password
Changes password for Parental Control and Country Code.
32
Parental Control
Sets the Parental Control depending on the disc content.
32
Country Code
Sets your Country Code.
32
Internet Connection
Sets the internet connection to Enable/Disable.
32
Connection Setting
Sets a network connection method.
32
Information
Displays network information screen.
33
Connection Test
Performs the network connection test.
33
IP Setting
Sets the IP setting to Auto/Manual.
33
BD-Live
Connection
Sets the BD-Live connection to Permitted/Partial Permitted/
Prohibited.
33
DLNA
Sets the DLNA to Enable/Disable.
33
Proxy Setting
Sets the proxy setting.
33
3D Playback
Message
Language
Function
32
SETUP menu
Menu/Submenu
TV
Display Setting
Audio Output
Function
Page
Selects 3D or 2D videos.
33
TV Screen
Sets the screen aspect ratio of the connected TV, and adjust
the video output.
33
Video Out Select
Selects the resolution of video output.
34
TV System
Selects the TV System from NTSC/PAL/Multi.
34
Color Space
Selects Color Space from YCbCr 4:4:4/YCbCr 4:2:2/Full
RGB/RGB.
34
HDMI Deep Color
Selects HDMI Deep Color from 30 bits/36 bits/48 bits/Off.
34
HDMI 1080p 24Hz
Sets HDMI 1080p 24Hz to auto/off.
34
Lip Sync
Adjusts the lag between video and audio, such as when the
mouth movement is out of sync with the voice.
34
Video Mode
Adjusts the visual image.
34
Color Adjust
Adjusts Brightness/Saturation/Hue for each color.
35
Noise Reduction
Sets the level of Noise Reduction.
35
De-interlacing
Mode
Sets how to detect the video signal.
Coaxial / Optical
Selects the output mode of COAXIAL jack/OPTICAL
terminal from Bitstream/PCM/Reencode/Off.
35
HDMI
Selects the output mode of HDMI terminal from Bitstream/
PCM/Reencode/Off.
35
Downsampling
Selects the digital audio signal down sampling frequency
from 48K/96K/192K.
35
35
Audio Setting
4
Settings
Video Process
Item
3D Output
35
DRC
Sets the DRC (Dynamic Range Compression).
Speaker Setting
2ch Downmix
Sets the audio output from AUDIO OUT L/R jack.
35
Post Process
UpMix
Multi-channelizes the 2-channel audio signal.
35
Displays software version and MAC address (p. 43).
29 En
English
35
System
Information
SETUP menu
■ Example of SETUP menu
operation
You need to call up the SETUP menu screen to perform
settings for this Player. The following is the explanation
for basic operations of the SETUP menu.
SUBTITLE
4. Enter password.
Enter your password with number buttons.
– The default password is 0000.
– You cannot move to the next setting screen until
you have input the correct password.
– To change the password, refer to “Change
Password” (p. 32).
ANGLE
AUDIO
CLEAR
PIP
SEARCH
SHUFFLE
SETUP
TOP MENU
2ND
REPEAT
POP-UP MENU
ENTER
RETURN
ON SCREEN
Example: Setting Parental Control
Note
– Some items cannot be set during playback. In this
case, press
twice to stop playback completely
before setting.
5. Select a next item.
Press 5/a to select the Parental Control Level for
Blu-ray Disc/DVD, then press ENTER.
1. Display the SETUP menu screen.
Press SETUP to display the SETUP menu screen.
Press 2/3 to select General Setting, then press
ENTER or a.
2. Select a Submenu.
Press 5/a to select Security, then press ENTER or
cursor 3.
3. Select a menu item.
Press 5/a to select Parental Control, then press
ENTER or cursor 3.
30 En
6. Exit the menu screen.
Press 2 to return to the previous menu.
SETUP menu
■ General Setting
The default settings are marked with “ ”.
*
System
Screen Saver
You can set the screen saver to on/off.
When set to on, this Player will switch to screen saver
mode if there is no operation for 3 minutes. After that, this
Player will turn to standby mode when there is no
operation for 27 minutes.
On*, Off
On*, Off
HDMI Control
You can set the Player to receive control signal from a
TV/AV receiver compatible with the HDMI Control
function via an HDMI cable (p. 12).
On, Off*
• Automatic input select function
When you start playback of this Player, the input
selector of the TV (and an AV receiver if this Player is
connected to the TV via the AV receiver) is switched
to this Player automatically. TV Power is turned on
automatically depending on the TV.
• Automatic power off function
When you turn off the TV while this Player is in stop
mode and the SETUP menu screen is not displayed,
the power of this Player is also turned off
automatically.
Notes
– When Network Control is enable, power
consumption during standby mode increases due to
network control function.
– When set to On, the system startup time is
decreased.
Load Default
You can reset all settings of this Player to default setting
except Security setting (p. 32). For details on default
settings, see pages 28–35.
Upgrade
You can upgrade the software manually from USB
Storage or Network. For details on software upgrade, refer
to “Software upgrade” (p. 38).
4
Easy Setup
You can perform Easy Setup (p. 18).
Local Storage
You can display Local Storage information, format Local
Storage, and select Front USB/Rear USB to save the BDLive data.
To format (empty) the “BUDA” folder in the USB
memory device, select Information and press ENTER
when “Format” is focused on the screen.
Front USB, Rear USB*
English
Using HDMI Control function
Using the HDMI Control function, you can interactively
operate this Player with your TV (HDMI Control
function supported).
When you connect this Player to the TV compatible with
the HDMI Control function using an HDMI cable and
set HDMI Control in the SETUP menu to on (p. 31), you
can perform the function listed below.
On, Off*
Settings
Disc Auto Playback
You can set Disc Auto Playback to on/off. When set to on,
a disc will play back automatically after loading.
Network Control
You can set control via Ethernet to On/Off. This Player
employs Yamaha Network Control protocol (YNC).
Hint
– Local Storage is used as an auxiliary memory when
Blu-ray Disc is played back.
3D Playback Message
You can turn on or off a warning message concerning 3D
video playback that appears on the TV when this Player is
turned on.
On*, Off
Notes
Language
– HDMI Control function may not work properly
depending on the TV.
– Functions other than ones shown above may work
depending on the TV or AV receiver.
– In order to make the HDMI Control function
available, set up settings for the HDMI Control
function on ALL components (this Player, TV,
and AV receiver). Certain operation may also be
required.
– Each function may be set independently to
activate/deactivate depending on the TV.
– Refer to the operation manuals supplied with the
TV and/or AV receiver for details regarding setup.
– When set to on, power consumption during
standby mode increases due to HDMI Control
function.
OSD
You can select the language for On Screen Display which
is the messages or menu displayed on the screen such as
SETUP menu.
English, Français , Español , Deutsch , Italiano , Svenska ,
,
Nederlandse ,
Menu
You can prioritize the language for disc menu.
English, Français ,
, Español , Deutsch , Italiano ,
Nederlandse , Portuguese, Danish, Svenska , Finnish,
Norwegian,
, Korean, Japanese, More
31 En
SETUP menu
Audio
You can prioritize the audio language for Blu-ray Disc/
DVD playback. For details on setting items, see “Menu”
(p. 31).
Subtitle
You can prioritize the language for Subtitle.
English, Français ,
, Español , Deutsch , Italiano ,
Nederlandse , Portuguese, Danish, Svenska , Finnish,
Norwegian,
, Korean, Japanese, More, Off
(The default settings in [Language] differ depending on
your model.)
Playback
Closed Caption
You can set to display the closed caption (p. 42) when
Blu-ray Disc/ DVD with closed caption is played back.
On*, Off
Angle Mark
You can set to display the Angle Mark (
) when
Blu-ray Disc/DVD with multiple angles is played back.
On*, Off
PIP Mark
You can set to display the PIP Mark (
) when Blu-ray
Disc with picture in picture (p. 27) is played back.
On*, Off
Secondary Audio Mark
You can set to display the Secondary Audio Mark (
)
when Blu-ray Disc with secondary audio is played back.
On*, Off
Last Memory
You can set whether this Player remembers the last
playback position of a disc when it is set to standby mode
or the disc tray is opened.
On*, Off
Note
– Some discs are not compatible with this function.
DivX(R) VOD DRM
You can display registration code for DivX(R) video.
Netflix Information
You can deactivate this Player from Netflix and display
ESN (Electronic Serial Number). To activate this Player
again, refer to “Playing videos from Netflix™” (p. 23).
ESN (Electronic Serial Number) is a unique number that
allows you to use Netflix streaming.
32 En
Security
Change Password
You can set the password for changing the Parental
Control Level and Country Code. Refer to “Parental
Control” (p. 32) and “Country Code” (p. 32).
Notes
– The default password is 0000.
– If you forget the password, refer to
“Troubleshooting” (p. 39) and set all the Security
settings to their default settings.
Parental Control
In some Blu-ray Discs/DVDs, a control level for disc
viewing is set depending on the age of the viewer. You
can set the Parental Control shown on the screen
depending on the disc content.
The password (see “Change Password” on p. 32) needs to
be entered before the Parental Control Levels is set.
After you set the Parental Control, when you play back a
disc with level higher than current Parental Control Level,
or you want to change the Parental Control Level, a dialog
box will pop up to ask you to enter the password.
Off*, 1–8
Country Code
You can set the Country Code you live in. The password
(see “Change Password” on p. 32) needs to be entered
before the Country Code is set. This setting may be used
for rating of Parental Control and disc playback.
Network
Internet Connection
Set this item to Enable when you use BD-Live (p. 27), DLNA
(p. 20), software upgrade from the network (p. 38), and the
other network functions.
Enable*, Disable
Connection Setting
You can select a network connection method.
Wired*
Connects the network using Ethernet.
Wireless
Connects the network using a wireless LAN.
You can select settings for a wireless LAN
connection. Follow the on-screen instructions to
proceed.
Scan
Searches for an access point. You can connect the
access point that is found.
Manual
You can manually set information for an access
point.
SETUP menu
Information
You can display network information screen. On this
screen, you can view the information of Interface
(Ethernet), Address Type, IP Address, Subnet Mask,
Default Gateway, and DNS.
■ Display Setting
Connection Test
You can perform an internet connection test. If the test is
failed, please check “IP Setting” (p. 33) and perform the
test again.
3D Output
You can select 3D or 2D video output from this Player.
IP Setting
You can configure the network settings.
Select to automatically configure the network
settings of this Player with the DHCP server.
Manual
Select to configure the network settings (IP Address,
Subnet Mask, Default Gateway, and DNS) manually.
Hints
–
–
–
–
Numeric keys
2/3
CLEAR
ENTER
Enters characters.
Moves the highlight.
Deletes a character.
Saves the settings and exits from
the menu.
BD-Live Connection
You can set access restriction to BD-Live contents.
Permitted
Allows all BD-Live discs to connect the network.
Partial
Permitted*
Allows only discs with owner certification.
Prohibited
Prohibits all BD-Live discs to connect the network.
Enable*, Disable
Proxy Setting
You can set Proxy Setting. Set to Disable for normal use.
Set to Enable to set the proxy setting.
Enable
Enables proxy host and proxy port setting.
Disable*
Sets proxy server to disable. Select this item when
proxy server is not used.
Proxy Host
Sets proxy host.
Proxy Port
Sets proxy port.
Auto*
This Player automatically selects 3D or 2D videos.
Off
This Player always selects 2D videos.
Note
– Even if you set “3D Output” to “Auto” and play
back a Blu-ray 3D Disc, this Player selects 2D
images depending on the connection and the setting
of TV, etc (p. 12).
TV Screen
You can set the screen aspect ratio of the connected TV,
and adjust the video output.
If you switch your TV (i.e. because you have bought a
new one) and the screen aspect ratio of the connected TV
changes, you will have to change the TV Screen setting.
16:9 Full
4
Select this when this Player is connected to a TV
with a 16:9 screen. When a 4:3 aspect ratio video is
played back, the video is displayed as shown below.
16:9 Normal* Select this when this Player is connected to a TV
with a 16:9 screen. When a 4:3 aspect ratio video is
played back, the video is displayed as shown below.
4:3 Pan Scan Select this when this Player is connected to a TV
with a 4:3 screen. When a 16:9 aspect ratio video is
played back, the video is displayed as shown below.
4:3 Letter Box Select this when this Player is connected to a TV
with a 4:3 screen. When a 16:9 aspect ratio video is
played back, the video is displayed as shown below.
Original
image size
On 16:9 (wide screen) TV
16:9 Full
16:9 Normal
4:3
Original
image size
On 4:3 TV
4:3 Pan Scan
4:3 Letter Box
16:9
33 En
English
DLNA
You can set the DLNA (p. 42) to Enable/Disable. When
you do not use the DLNA function, set to Disable.
TV
Settings
Auto*
The default settings are marked with “ * ”.
SETUP menu
Video Out Select
You can select the video output resolution from HDMI,
COMPONENT, and VIDEO. For more details on output
formats, refer to “About the video output formats” (p. 37).
HDMI
When set to Auto, resolution is set to the maximum
resolution according to the connected TV.
When set to Disc Native, the original resolution and
video frequency, recorded in the Blu-ray Disc or
DVD that is played back, are used. You can use a
video up-converter function of an external device.
When other than a Blu-ray Disc or DVD is played
back, the resolution and video frequency will work
as Auto.
If a Blu-ray Disc or DVD whose resolution and
video frequency are not compatible with the
connected TV, no image will be output. In this case,
stop playback, and select an option other than Disc
Native.
Auto*, Disc Native, 480i/576i, 480p/576p,
720p, 1080i, 1080p
HDMI Deep Color
When your TV and/or AV receiver is compatible with
Deep Color (p. 42), set this item according to your TV/AV
receiver. This function is available when this Player is
connected with an HDMI cable.
30 bits, 36 bits, 48 bits, Off*
HDMI 1080p 24Hz
This outputs the BD-Video encoded in 24Hz frame rate in
HDMI 1080p 24Hz. Smoother video playback may be
available with this function. This function is available
when your TV/AV receiver support this function, and this
Player is connected with an HDMI cable. For more details
on output formats, refer to “About the video output
formats” (p. 37).
Auto*, Off
Note
COMPONENT You can select only 480p/576p or 480i/576i.
– This setting is disabled when output resolution is
other than 1080p.
480p/576p, 481i/576i*
VIDEO
This works as same as 480i/576i.
Notes
– To output HD audio (Dolby TrueHD or DTS-HD
Master Audio) from HDMI terminal, set Video Out
Select to Auto or more than 720p.
– If a TV is connected with an HDMI cable, default
setting will be HDMI.
– If a TV is not connected with an HDMI cable,
default setting is VIDEO.
TV System
You can select TV System from PAL, NTSC and Multi.
Set the same TV System as your TV set. For more details
on output formats, refer to “About the video output
formats” (p. 37).
NTSC, PAL, Multi
(The default setting differs depending on your model.)
Color Space
You can select the Color Space (p. 42) output from
HDMI. This function is available when this Player is
connected with an HDMI cable.
YCbCr 4:4:4* Sets Color Space to YCbCr 4:4:4.
YCbCr 4:2:2
Sets Color Space to YCbCr 4:2:2.
Full RGB
When RGB is set and white and black on the screen
are too faint, select this item. This setting is effective
when a connected component supports RGB 0–255
range.
RGB
Outputs video signal at normal signal range.
Note
– This function is only available on TVs that support
this function.
Lip Sync
You can set/adjust the Lip Sync (p. 43) function.
Auto*
This Player adjusts the Lip Sync function
automatically.
Manual
You can adjust the Lip Sync function manually. You
can set the delay of the audio for 2D and 3D contents
independently.
2D
3D
Off
This Player does not adjust the Lip Sync function.
Video Process
Video Mode
You can select Video Mode below.
Standard*
The image is most natural and well-balanced. This
mode suits for normal use.
Vivid
The image is more vivid and sharp.
Cinema
The image suits for watching movie in dark room.
Custom
You can adjust the visual image manually. Press
5/a to select the parameter, then press 2/3 to
adjust the figure.
Brightness
Adjusts the overall brightness of the image.
Saturation
Adjusts the richness of the color in the projected
image.
Hue
Adjusts the tint of the projected image.
Contrast
Adjusts the bright areas (white levels) in the image.
Sharpness
Adjusts the sharpness of objects in the video.
CTI
Smoothes out the edges of color images. Color
images are rendered more distinct.
The default settings are 0.
34 En
SETUP menu
Color Adjust
You can adjust Brightness/Saturation/Hue for each color
(Red/Green/Blue/Yellow/Cyan/Magenta). To use this
function, set Video Mode to Custom. For details on the
setting items, see “Video Mode” (p. 34).
The default settings are 0.
Noise Reduction
You can set the Noise Reduction to a level of 0 to 3. 0 is
off, and 3 is the maximum level.
DRC
You can set the DRC (Dynamic Range Compression)
(p. 42) to on/off/Auto. When set to Auto, DRC is
automatically turned on for a source with DRC
information in Dolby TrueHD format. DRC makes the
strong sound such as plosive sound lower, and
conversations more audible. It is useful when you watch
movies in the night.
Off, On, Auto*
0, 1, 2*, 3
Speaker Setting
2ch Downmix
You can select down mix method to analog 2-ch from
Stereo or Lt/Rt.
Auto*, Film, Video
Lt/Rt
■ Audio Setting
Select this item if this unit is connected to a Dolby
Pro Logic decoder. Sound from rear speakers is
mixed to the 2-ch stereo sound.
Stereo*
Changes channel output to stereo, which only
delivers sound from the two front speakers.
The default settings are marked with “ * ”.
Audio Output
Post Process
Coaxial / Optical
You can select the output mode of COAXIAL jack and
OPTICAL terminal. For more details on output formats,
refer to “About the audio output formats” (p. 36).
UpMix
You can multi-channelize the 2-channel audio signal. To
multi-channelize, select DTS NEO:6, then select Cinema
or Music mode.
Bitstream
Off*, DTS NEO:6
Outputs digital signal without any processing.
Secondary Audio is not output.
Outputs 2-channel PCM.
Reencode*
Outputs Bitstream with Secondary Audio.
■ System Information
Off
Mutes sound.
Software version and MAC address (p. 43) are displayed.
HDMI
You can select the output mode of HDMI terminal. For
details on setting items, see “Coaxial / Optical” (p. 35). For
more details on output formats, refer to “About the audio
output formats” (p. 36).
Bitstream*, PCM, Reencode, Off
Note
– To output HD audio (Dolby TrueHD or DTS-HD
Master Audio) from HDMI terminal, set Video Out
Select to Auto or more than 720p (p. 34).
Downsampling
You can select digital audio signal down-sample
frequency. This function is effective for the audio signal
output from the COAXIAL jack/OPTICAL terminal.
48K*
The highest sampling rate of digital PCM output is
48 kHz.
96K
The highest sampling rate of digital PCM output is
96 kHz.
192K
The highest sampling rate of digital PCM output is
192 kHz.
35 En
English
PCM
4
Settings
De-interlacing Mode
You can select how to detect the video signal. Set to Auto
for normal use. When horizontal stripping noise appears
on the screen, set this to Film/Video to remove the noise.
SETUP menu
■ About the audio output formats
Source format
PCM 2ch
PCM 5.1ch
PCM 7.1ch
HDMI
Bitstream
with SA* or
BCS**
PCM 2ch
without SA*
or BCS**
with SA* or
BCS**
PCM 5.1ch
PCM 7.1ch
PCM up to
5.1ch
Dolby Digital
Plus
PCM up to
7.1ch
Dolby
TrueHD
PCM up to
7.1ch
DTS
PCM up to
5.1ch
with SA* or
DTS HD High BCS**
Resolution
without SA*
or BCS**
DTS HD High
Resolution
PCM up to
7.1ch
with SA* or
BCS**
DTS-HD
Master Audio without SA*
or BCS**
DTS-HD
Master Audio
PCM up to
7.1ch
without SA*
or BCS**
with SA* or
Dolby Digital BCS**
Plus
without SA*
or BCS**
Dolby
TrueHD
DTS
with SA* or
BCS**
without SA*
or BCS**
with SA* or
BCS**
without SA*
or BCS**
Dolby Digital
PCM
PCM 2ch
MIXED 2CH
Reencode
–
Dolby Digital
2ch
PCM 2ch
Dolby Digital
PCM 2ch
2ch
Dolby Digital
PCM 2ch
Dolby Digital
PCM 2ch
PCM 7.1ch
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital
Bitstream
PCM 5.1ch
without SA*
or BCS**
with SA* or
BCS**
COAXIAL / OPTICAL
Reencode
PCM 2ch
without SA*
or BCS**
with SA* or
BCS**
PCM
2ch
Dolby Digital
PCM 2ch
Dolby Digital Dolby Digital
2ch
2ch
2ch
PCM 2ch
Dolby Digital
2ch
Dolby Digital
PCM 2ch
Dolby Digital
2ch
Dolby Digital
PCM 2ch
Dolby Digital
2ch
DTS
PCM 2ch
DTS
2ch
DTS
PCM 2ch
DTS
2ch
DTS
PCM 2ch
DTS
2ch
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital
Plus
Dolby Digital
Dolby
TrueHD
DTS
DTS
DTS HD High
Resolution
DTS
DTS-HD
Master Audio
* “SA” is a Secondary Audio.
** “BCS” is a button click sound, the sound effect for pop-up menus, etc.
Notes
– When Coaxial / Optical or HDMI is set to Bitstream, secondary audio is not output. (p. 35)
– To output HD audio (Dolby TrueHD or DTS-HD Master Audio) from HDMI terminal, set Video Out Select to
Auto or more than 720p (p. 34).
36 En
SETUP menu
■ About the video output formats
When TV System is set to NTSC
Video Out Select
Contents
Output
terminal
HDMI
Auto
Disc Native
*1
*2
off
BD-Video
HDMI
without
COMPONENT
1080p/24Hz
VIDEO
content
*1
*3
*2
off
*1
*3
*2
*2
*1
*1
HDMI
DVD-Video COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
Others
COMPONENT
VIDEO
*2
1080p 24Hz
*2
1080i
1080p 24Hz/
1080i 60Hz
60Hz *4
off
off
1080p 60Hz 1080i 60Hz
off
off
1080p 60Hz 1080i 60Hz
off
off
1080p 60Hz 1080i 60Hz
off
off
COMPONENT
VIDEO
720p
480p/576p
480i/576i
480p/576p
480i/576i
–
720p 60Hz
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
off
720p 60Hz
off
720p 60Hz
off
720p 60Hz
off
4
Settings
BD-Video
HDMI
with
1080p/24Hz COMPONENT
content
VIDEO
1080p
When TV System is set to PAL
Video Out Select
Contents
Output
terminal
HDMI
Disc Native
BD-Video
HDMI
with
1080p/24Hz COMPONENT
content
VIDEO
*1
1080p 24Hz
*2
off
BD-Video
HDMI
without
COMPONENT
1080p/24Hz
VIDEO
content
*1
*3
*2
off
*1
*3
*2
*2
*1
*1
*2
*2
HDMI
DVD-Video COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
Others
COMPONENT
VIDEO
1080p
1080i
1080p 24Hz/
1080i 50Hz
50Hz *4
off
off
1080p 50Hz 1080i 50Hz
off
off
1080p 50Hz 1080i 50Hz
off
off
1080p 50Hz 1080i 50Hz
off
off
COMPONENT
VIDEO
720p
480p/576p
480i/576i
480p/576p
480i/576i
–
720p 50Hz
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
off
720p 50Hz
off
720p 50Hz
off
720p 50Hz
off
*1 Resolution will be set to the maximum resolution supported by the connected TV. For example, when the maximum
resolution supported by the connected TV is 1080p, the resolution will be set to 1080p.
*2 Video might not be output because HDMI output has priority.
*3 Resolution will be that of the source disc.
*4 If Auto is set for HDMI 1080p 24Hz and the connected TV supports 1080p 24Hz content, 1080p 24 Hz will be output
instead of 1080p 50/60 Hz.
When TV System is set to Multi
When TV System is set to Multi, video signal is output at the same frequency as the source. Refer to the tables above for
details on the frequency setting of the TV and resolution of the output video signal.
Notes
– HDMI 1080p 24Hz setting is disabled when output resolution is other than 1080p.
– When TV System is set to NTSC and video source is not 60 Hz, the video output signal is converted to 60 Hz.
– When TV System is set to PAL and video source is not 50 Hz, the video output signal is converted to 50 Hz.
37 En
English
Auto
Software upgrade
Some of the newly released Blu-ray Discs cannot be played back unless you upgrade this Player software to the latest
version. We recommend upgrading the software of this Player with software upgrade so that this Player is operated based
on the latest software.
To check for the availability of a software upgrade, visit
http://download.yamaha.com/
Note
– Do not remove the USB memory device, set this Player to standby mode or unplug the power cable/LAN cable
while the software upgrade is being performed.
■ Upgrading the software
1. Prepare for the software upgrade.
When you upgrade the software from USB Storage:
1 Save the upgrade file package to the appropriate
folder on the USB memory device. For more
details, refer to the procedure document attached
with the upgrade file package.
2 Connect the USB memory device.
Skip step 2.
When you upgrade the software from Network:
Confirm that this Player is connected to the
network.
2. Select the upgrade method and
start upgrade from SETUP menu.
1 Press SETUP to display SETUP menu screen.
2 Select General Setting = System = Upgrade.
3 Select the item which contains the upgrade file
package from USB Storage/Network.
The system will search for upgrade file package.
38 En
3. Upgrade the software by following
the on-screen messages.
Upgrade is completed. The system will be reset.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Troubleshooting
Refer to the table below when this Player does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed
below or if the instruction below does not help, turn off this Player, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest
authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
■ Power
Problem
Possible causes and solutions
No power.
– Connect the AC power cable properly.
– Press p on the front panel to turn on the power.
The Player power is turned off.
– The power will be automatically turned off after 30 continuous minutes of inactivity (no
playback).
5
■ Basic operation
Possible causes and solutions
– Use the remote control within its operating range. (p. 9)
– Replace the batteries. (p. 9)
– Check the ID settings for the main unit and the remote control. The remote control ID
on the main unit may be changed after the main unit is reset. In this case, verify the
remote control ID on the main unit, and set it again if needed. (p. 9)
Buttons do not work.
– Press and hold p on the front panel for more than 5 seconds, and release to reset this
Player.
– To completely reset this Player, unplug the power cable from the AC outlet for 10
seconds or more, plug the power cable to the AC outlet again, and then turn on this
Player.
Password is forgotten.
– Press and hold
and
on the front panel simultaneously when no disc is inserted
and playback is stopped to set all the settings including Security settings (p. 32) of this
Player to their default settings. After the power is turned off automatically, press p to
turn on the power again.
Additional information
Problem
The remote control does not work.
English
■ Disc playback
Problem
Possible causes and solutions
The Player cannot play a disc.
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Video stops.
– The Player will stop if it senses shock or vibration.
The Player makes a snapping sound
when starting playback or loading a
disc.
– These sounds are not malfunctions of the Player but are normal operating conditions.
Take out the disc and clean it. (p. 4)
Make sure that the disc is loaded properly (aligned in disc tray and label-side up). (p. 4)
Use a disc supported by the Player. (p. 3)
Remove the disc and then check whether the Player supports the disc or not. (p. 3)
Check the region code. (p. 3)
Check whether the disc is defective by trying another disc.
The CD-R/RW, DVD+R/RW/R DL, and DVD-R/RW/R DL must be finalized. (p. 3)
39 En
Troubleshooting
■ Picture
Problem
Possible causes and solutions
No picture.
– Make sure that the cables are connected correctly. (p. 10)
– Make sure that the connected TV or the AV receiver is set to the correct input. (p. 10)
– With no disc inserted, or playback stopped, press and hold
and
on the front
panel simultaneously to set video resolution to the default value.
If a picture is still not output, press and hold
on the front panel for approximately 5
seconds to switch NTSC/PAL.
– When set to Disc Native, a signal that is not compatible with the connected TV is
output. Change the setting to output a signal that is compatible with the connected TV.
(p. 34)
Screen freezes and operation buttons
do not work.
– Press , then restart playback.
– Turn off the power and turn on the power again.
– Press and hold p on the front panel for more than 5 seconds, and release to reset this
Player.
Video is not output with the desired
resolution.
– Set to the desired resolution. (p. 34)
Wide-screen video appears vertically
stretched, or black bands appear at the
top and bottom of the screen. Or 4:3
video appears horizontally stretched.
– Change the aspect ratio of your TV. (p. 33)
Square noise (mosaic) appears on the
screen.
– Blocks in images may be visible in scenes with rapid movement due to the
characteristics of digital image compression technology.
The playback screen will be disturbed if
DVD video is recorded to a VCR, or
played back through a VCR.
– This Player complies with analog copy protection. Some discs contain a copy
prohibiting signal. If you try to play back such discs through a VCR, or record to a VCR
and play back the signal, the copy protection will prevent normal playback.
Audio is not output, or images are not
played back properly.
– The audio may not be output or the images may not be played back properly for some
discs in which copyright-protected contents are recorded.
■ Sound
Problem
Possible causes and solutions
No sound, or sound is distorted.
–
–
–
–
Left and right channels of audio are
reversed, or sound comes out of only
one side.
– Check the audio connection. (p. 10)
Audio is not output, or images are not
played back properly.
– The audio may not be output or the images may not be played back properly for some
discs in which copyright-protected contents are recorded.
Cannot hear the desired audio type and/
or number of channels.
– Refer to Audio Output setting and “About the audio output formats”. (p. 35, p. 36)
Cannot hear the sound of PIP
(secondary audio).
– Set Coaxial / Optical or HDMI to PCM/Reencode. (p. 35)
– To hear secondary audio, press 2ND AUDIO. (p. 6)
– Depending on the disc, you may need to set secondary audio on the top menu of the
disc. (p. 8)
Check that the audio cable is connected correctly. (p. 10)
Turn the volume of TV or AV receiver up.
There is no sound during still mode, fast forward, and fast reverse. (p. 8)
Audio may not be output depending on the audio recording status, such as when audio
other than an audio signal or non-standard audio is recorded for the audio content. (p. 3)
■ Network
Problem
Cannot connect to the Internet.
40 En
Possible causes and solutions
– When connecting to the Internet by selecting Wired in Connection Setting, connect the
Network cable properly. (p. 32)
– Turn on the connected equipment, such as broadband router or modem.
– Connect the broadband router and/or modem properly.
– If Wireless is selected in Connection Setting, and when you want to connect to the
Internet using Ethernet, select Wired properly. (p. 32)
– Properly select Wireless in Connection Setting when you want to connect to the Internet
using a wireless LAN. (p. 32)
Troubleshooting
Problem
Possible causes and solutions
Cannot detect the DLNA server.
– Verify that this Player can connect to the network normally. Refer to “Connection
Test”. (p. 33)
– Turn on the connected equipment, such as broadband router or the server.
– Confirm the Player and the server are connected to the same access point.
– Depending on the DLNA server, the Player may need to be permitted from the server.
– Depending on the DLNA server, it needs to change a firewall setting.
Cannot play the file on the DLNA server.
– Make sure the file is playable. (p. 3)
– Check your DLNA server’s setting.
– The playback and operating quality may be affected by your home network condition.
Cannot connect to the Internet via
Wireless LAN.
– Make sure that the wireless LAN router is turned on.
– Depending on the surrounding environment, such as the wall material, radio wave
receiving condition, or obstacles between the Player and the wireless LAN router, the
communication distance may be shortened. Move the Player and the wireless LAN
router closer to each other.
– Devices that use a 2.4 GHz frequency band, such as a microwave, Bluetooth, or digital
cordless device, may interrupt the communication. Move the Player away from such
devices, or turn off such devices.
– If the Internet connection using a wireless LAN is still not successful by the above two
solutions, try using Ethernet by selecting Wired in Connection Setting. (p. 32)
Wireless network is not found or
distorted.
– If Scan is performed but the wireless network is not found or distorted, press RETURN
to return to the previous screen, and try Scan again. If the desired wireless router is still
not detected, press RETURN to select Manual.
– Make sure that the wireless network is not disturbed by microwave ovens, DECT
phones, or other neighboring Wi-Fi devices.
– Microwave ovens, DECT phones or other wireless devices in your neighborhood might
disturb the wireless network. Turn off these devices.
– Make sure that the firewalls in your network allow access to the wireless connection of
this Player.
– If the wireless network does not work properly in your home, try the wired network
connection.
■ Messages on the screen
– The following messages appear on the TV screen in case the disc you tried to play back is not appropriate or the
operation is not correct.
Error message
Possible causes and solutions
Unsupported File
– The file is not supported with this Player. See “Types of discs/files that can be used with this Player”
(p. 3).
Wrong region code!
– The disc is an incompatible region code. See “Region management information for Blu-ray Disc/
DVD videos” (p. 3).
Network has FAILED.
– This Player cannot be connected to the network. Check connection (p. 16) and Network setting (p. 32).
Network is OK, proxy has
FAILED.
– This Player cannot be connected to the proxy server. See “Proxy Setting” (p. 33).
BD-Live connection is
prohibited in SETUP menu.
– BD-Live connection is prohibited. See “BD-Live Connection” (p. 33).
Upgrade has failed for some
reason!
– Upgrade is failed. Check if the upgrade file is corrupted or unreadable.
IP Setting is not valid! Please
reset…
– The IP Setting entered is not valid. Enter the correct information again.
41 En
5
English
– Verify that this Player can connect to the Internet normally. Refer to “Connection Test”.
(p. 33)
– Connect USB memory device properly. Check that the USB memory device is
connected to the USB connector of this Player. (p. 16)
– Check if the Blu-ray Disc supports BD-Live.
– Connect the USB memory device formatted in FAT16, FAT32, or NTFS.
– It is recommended to connect the USB memory device with at least 2 GB of free space.
If there is not enough free space, format the USB memory device. (p. 31)
– Refer to the supplied user’s manual of the disc or consult the disc manufacturer.
Additional information
Cannot download BD-Live contents.
Glossary
AVCHD
AVCHD is a new format (standard) for high definition
video cameras that can be used to record and play highresolution HD images.
BD-Live™
BD-Live is a Blu-ray Disc standard that utilizes a
network connection, enabling this Player to go online to
download promotional videos and other data.
BDMV
BDMV (Blu-ray Disc Movie) refers to one of the
application formats used for BD-ROM which is one of
the Blu-ray Disc specifications. BDMV is a recording
format equivalent to DVD-Video of the DVD
specification.
Blu-ray 3D™
Blu-ray 3D enables you to view full high definition 3D
images.
BONUSVIEW™
BONUSVIEW compatible discs let you simultaneously
enjoy video sub-channel for two screens, audio subchannel and sub-titles. A small screen appears within
the main screen during playback (Picture in Picture).
Closed Caption
Closed captions are kind of subtitle, and the difference
between subtitles and captions is that subtitles are
intended for hearing persons and captions are for the
hearing impaired. Subtitles rarely show all of the audio.
For example, captions show sound effects (e.g., “phone
ringing” and “footsteps”), while subtitles do not. Before
you select this setting, please ensure that the disc
contains closed caption information.
Color Space
Color Space is a color range that can be represented.
RGB is a color space based on the RGB color model
(red, green and blue) and is typically used for PC
monitors. YCbCr is a color space based on a luminance
signal (Y) and two color difference signals (Cb and Cr).
Deep Color
Deep Color refers to the use of various color depths in
displays, up from the 24-bit depths in previous versions
of the HDMI specification. This extra bit depth allows
HDTVs and other displays go from millions of colors to
billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding
for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations
between colors. The increased contrast ratio can
represent many times more shades of gray between
black and white. Also Deep Color increases the number
of available colors within the boundaries defined by the
RGB or YCbCr color space.
42 En
DLNA
DLNA (Digital Living Network Alliance) provides easy
sharing of digital media through network in the home,
and you can enjoy digital contents stored on your
DLNA-server-software-installed PC or other DLNA
compatible device with your TV via this Player. To
connect this Player to your DLNA servers, some
settings for the DLNA server or device are required. For
details, refer to your DLNA server software or DLNA
device.
DivX®
DivX® is a digital video format created by DivX, LLC,
a subsidiary of Rovi Corporation. This is an official
DivX Certified® device that plays DivX video. Visit
divx.com for more information and software tools to
convert your files into DivX videos.
Dolby Digital
A sound system developed by Dolby Laboratories Inc.
that gives movie theater ambience to audio output when
the product is connected to a Dolby Digital processor or
amplifier.
Dolby Digital Plus
A sound system developed as an extension to Dolby
Digital. This audio coding technology supports 7.1
multi-channel surround sound.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is a lossless coding technology that
supports up to 8 channels of multi-channel surround
sound for the next generation optical discs. The
reproduced sound is true to the original source bit-forbit.
DRC (Dynamic Range Control)
DRC lets you adjust the range between the loudest and
softest sounds (dynamic range) for playback at average
volume. Use this when it is hard to hear dialog, or
during times when playback may disturb neighbors.
DTS
This is a digital sound system developed by DTS, Inc.
for use in cinemas.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a new technology
developed for the next generation high definition optical
disc format.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is a lossless audio compression
technology developed for the next generation high
definition optical disc format.
Glossary
FLAC
Lip Sync
FLAC (Free Lossless Audio Codec) is an open file
format for lossless audio data compression. While
inferior in compression rate to other lossy compressed
audio formats, it can often provide higher audio quality.
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is an
interface that supports both video and audio on a single
digital connection. The HDMI connection carries
standard to high definition video signals and multichannel audio signals to AV components such as HDMI
equipped TVs, in digital form without degradation.
Letterbox (LB 4:3)
A screen size with black bars on the top and bottom of
the image to allow viewing of wide-screen (16:9)
material on a connected 4:3 TV.
Linear PCM Sound
Mac address
The Mac address is a unique value assigned to a network
device for identification purposes.
Pan Scan (PS 4:3)
A screen size that cuts off the sides of the image to allow
viewing of wide-screen (16:9) material on a connected
4:3 TV.
Subtitles
These are the lines of text appearing at the bottom of the
screen which translate or transcribe the dialog. They are
recorded on many DVDs and Blu-ray Discs.
x.v.Color
x.v.Color reproduces a greater range of color than
before, showing almost all of the colors that the human
eye can detect.
5
Additional information
Linear PCM is a signal recording format used for Audio
CDs and on some DVD and Blu-ray Discs. The sound
on Audio CDs is recorded at 44.1 kHz with 16 bits.
(Sound is recorded between 48 kHz with 16 bits and 96
kHz with 24 bits on DVD discs and between 48 kHz
with 16 bits and 192 kHz with 24 bits on Blu-ray Discs.)
Lip Sync, an abbreviation for lip synchronization, is a
technical term that involves both a problem and a
capability of maintaining audio and video signals
synchronized during post-production and transmission.
Whereas the audio and video latency requires complex
end-user adjustments, HDMI incorporates an automatic
audio and video syncing capability that allows devices
to perform this synchronization automatically and
accurately without user interaction.
Specifications
■ Input/output
Power supply
[U.S.A. and Canada models].................................. AC 110–240 V, 60 Hz
[Central and South America model] .................AC 110–240 V, 50/60 Hz
[Australia model] ................................................... AC 110–240 V, 50 Hz
[U.K., Europe and Russia model] .......................... AC 110–240 V, 50 Hz
[China model]......................................................... AC 110–240 V, 50 Hz
[Asia model]......................................................AC 110–240 V, 50/60 Hz
Power consumption (Normal) .............................................................. 20 W
Power consumption (Standby) ................................................. 0.5 W or less
Dimensions (W × H × D, including protrusions) ......... 435 × 86 × 257 mm
(17-1/8 × 3-3/8 × 10-1/8 in)
Weight ..................................................................................2.8 kg (6.2 lbs.)
HDMI output .............................................................. Type A connector × 1
480i/576i/480p/576p/720p/1080i/1080p/1080p@24Hz,
Deep Color, x.v. Color support
Component video output ..............................................Y: 1 Vp-p (75 ohms)
PB, PR: 0.7 Vp-p (75 ohms)
Video output......................................................................1 Vp-p (75 ohms)
Digital output.......................................................... Optical × 1, Coaxial × 1
Analog audio output ..............................................................Mixed 2 ch × 1
USB ............................................................................ Type A connector × 2
Wireless LAN.................................................. Standard: IEEE 802.11 b/g/n
Frequency range: 2.4GHz band
Other equipment ........................................................... Remote IN/OUT × 1
Ethernet × 1
■ Audio performance
Audio output level (1 kHz, 0 dB)
Blu-ray Disc/DVD/CD-DA.........................................................2 ± 0.3 V
Signal to noise ratio
Blu-ray Disc/DVD/CD-DA............................................................ 110 dB
Dynamic range
Blu-ray Disc/DVD ......................................................................... 105 dB
CD-DA ........................................................................................... 100 dB
Harmonic distortion (1 kHz)
Blu-ray Disc/DVD/CD-DA............................................................0.003%
Frequency Response
Blu-ray Disc/DVD ............................. 4 Hz to 22 kHz (48 kHz Sampling)
4 Hz to 44 kHz (96 kHz Sampling)
CD-DA ...............................................................................4 Hz to 20 kHz
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
43 En
English
■ General
Specifications
■ Copyright
– Audio-visual material may consist of copyrighted
works which must not be recorded without the
authority of the owner of the copyright. Refer to
relevant laws in your country.
– This item incorporates copy protection technology
that is protected by U.S. patents and other
intellectual property rights of Rovi Corporation.
Reverse engineering and disassembly are prohibited.
– Manufactured under license from Dolby
Laboratories. Dolby and the double-D symbol are
trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
– Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent Nos:
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535;
7,212,872; 7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other
U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTSHD, the Symbol, & DTS-HD and the Symbol
together are registered trademarks & DTS-HD
Master Audio is a trademark of DTS, Inc. Product
includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
– “Blu-ray Disc™”, “Blu-ray™”, “Blu-ray 3D™”,
“BD-Live™”, “BONUSVIEW™”, and the logos are
trademarks of the Blu-ray Disc Association.
–
is a trademark of DVD Format/Logo
Licensing Corporation.
– “HDMI,” the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition
Multimedia Interface” are trademarks, or registered
trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
– “x.v.Color” and “x.v.Color” logo are trademarks of
Sony Corporation.
– “AVCHD” and the “AVCHD” logo are trademarks
of Panasonic Corporation and Sony Corporation.
– Java and all Java-based trademarks and logos are
trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun
Microsystems, Inc. in the United States and/or other
countries.
– This product is licensed under the AVC patent
portfolio license and VC-1 patent portfolio license
for the personal and non-commercial use of a
consumer to (i) encode video in compliance with the
AVC Standard and VC-1 Standard (“AVC/VC-1
Video”) and/or (ii) decode AVC/VC-1 Video that
was encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal
and non-commercial activity and/or was obtained
from a video provider licensed to provide AVC/VC1 Video. No license is granted or shall be implied for
any other use. Additional information may be
obtained from MPEG LA, LLC.
See http://www.mpegla.com.
– Windows Media Player is a registered trademark or
trademark of Microsoft corporation in the United
States and/or other countries.
– YouTube and the YouTube logo, Picasa and the
Picasa logo are trademarks of Google. Inc.
– Netflix and the Netflix logo are the registered
trademarks of Netflix, Inc.
– DLNA and DLNA CERTIFIED are trademarks and/
or service marks of Digital Living Network Alliance.
– Copyright 2004-2010 Verance Corporation.
Cinavia™ is a Verance Corporation trademark.
Protected by U.S. Patent 7,369,677 and worldwide
patents issued and pending under license from
Verance Corporation. All rights reserved.
44 En
– The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED Logo is a certification mark
of the Wi-Fi Alliance.
– DivX®, DivX Certified®, DivX Plus® HD and
associated logos are trademarks of Rovi Corporation
or its subsidiaries and are used under license.
– DivX Certified® to play DivX® and DivX Plus®
HD (H.264/.MKV) video up to 1080p HD including
premium content.
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO: DivX® is a digital video format
created by DivX, LLC, a subsidiary of Rovi
Corporation. This is an official DivX Certified® device
that plays DivX video. Visit divx.com for more
information and software tools to convert your files into
DivX videos.
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO-ON-DEMAND: This DivX
Certified® device must be registered in order to play
purchased DivX Video-on-Demand (VOD) movies. To
obtain your registration code, locate the DivX VOD
section in your device setup menu. Go to vod.divx.com
for more information on how to complete your
registration.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Index
■
Numerics
2ch Downmix, SETUP menu ...............35
2ND AUDIO, remote control ................6
3D Output, SETUP menu ....................33
3D Playback Message, SETUP menu
.........................................................31
■
A
■
B
BD-Live ...............................................27
BD-Live Connection, SETUP menu ....33
Bitrate, On Screen menu ......................24
Bookmark .............................................26
■
C
G
General Setting, SETUP menu .............31
■
H
HDMI 1080p 24Hz, SETUP menu ......34
HDMI connection .................................12
HDMI Control function ........................31
HDMI Control, SETUP menu ..............31
HDMI Deep Color, SETUP menu .......34
HDMI, SETUP menu ...........................35
HOME menu ........................................18
HOME, remote control ...........................6
■
I
Information, SETUP menu ...................33
Initial Wizard .......................................18
Ins Replay, On Screen menu ................24
Ins Search, On Screen menu ................24
Internet Connection, SETUP menu ......32
IP Setting, SETUP menu ......................33
■
L
Language, SETUP menu ......................31
Last Memory, SETUP menu ................32
Lip Sync, SETUP menu .......................34
Load Default, SETUP menu ................31
Local Storage, SETUP menu ...............31
■
M
Netflix ..................................................23
Netflix Information, SETUP menu ......32
Network connection .............................16
Network Control, SETUP menu ..........31
Network, SETUP menu ........................32
Noise Reduction, SETUP menu ...........35
Number buttons, remote control ............6
■
■
D
Data disc playback ...............................18
De-interlacing Mode, SETUP menu ....35
DIGEST, remote control ........................6
Disc Auto Playback, SETUP menu .....31
Display Setting, SETUP menu .............33
DivX(R) VOD DRM, SETUP menu ...32
DLNA, SETUP menu ..........................33
Downsampling, SETUP menu .............35
DRC, SETUP menu .............................35
■
E
Easy Setup ............................................18
Easy Setup, SETUP menu ...................31
ENTER, remote control .........................8
ESN (Electronic Serial Number) .........32
MARKER, remote control .....................6
MEDIA menu .......................................18
Menu, SETUP menu ............................31
Mode/Play Mode, On Screen menu .....24
■
N
O
On Screen menu ...................................24
ON SCREEN, remote control ................8
OSD, SETUP menu ..............................31
Other connections .................................17
■
P
Parental Control, SETUP menu ...........32
Picture in Picture function ....................27
PIP Mark, SETUP menu ......................32
PIP, remote control .................................6
Playback, SETUP menu .......................32
POP UP/MENU, remote control ............8
Post Process, SETUP menu ..................35
Program play ........................................26
PROGRAM, remote control ...................6
Proxy Setting, SETUP menu ................33
R
Remote control ...................................... 6
REPEAT, remote control ....................... 7
RETURN, remote control ...................... 8
■
S
Screen Saver, SETUP menu ................ 31
Search function .................................... 26
SEARCH, remote control ...................... 7
Second Audio, On Screen menu .......... 24
Second Video, On Screen menu .......... 24
Secondary Audio Mark, SETUP menu
......................................................... 32
Security, SETUP menu ........................ 32
SETUP menu ....................................... 28
SETUP menu operation ....................... 30
SETUP, remote control ......................... 6
SHUFFLE, remote control .................... 7
Slide Show, On Screen menu .............. 24
Software upgrade ................................. 38
Speaker Setting, SETUP menu ............ 35
Status menu ......................................... 25
STATUS, remote control ....................... 6
Subtitle Style, On Screen menu ........... 24
Subtitle, On Screen menu .................... 24
SUBTITLE, remote control ................... 7
Subtitle, SETUP menu ......................... 32
System Information, SETUP menu ..... 35
System, SETUP menu ......................... 31
■
T
Time, On Screen menu ........................ 24
Title, On Screen menu ......................... 24
TOP MENU, remote control ................. 8
Track/File, On Screen menu ................ 24
Transition, On Screen menu ................ 24
TV Screen, SETUP menu .................... 33
TV System, SETUP menu ................... 34
TV, SETUP menu ................................ 33
■
U
Upgrade of software ............................ 38
Upgrade, SETUP menu ....................... 31
UpMix, SETUP menu ......................... 35
USB connection ................................... 16
USB content playback ......................... 18
■
V
Video connection ................................. 13
Video Mode, SETUP menu ................. 34
Video Out Select, SETUP menu ......... 34
Video output formats ........................... 37
Video Process, SETUP menu .............. 34
■
Y
YouTube playback ............................... 21
■
Z
ZOOM, remote control .......................... 6
45 En
5
English
Change Password, SETUP menu .........32
Chapter, On Screen menu ....................24
CLEAR, remote control .........................6
Closed Caption, SETUP menu .............32
Coaxial / Optical, SETUP menu ..........35
Code Page, On Screen menu ................24
Color Adjust, SETUP menu .................35
Color buttons, remote control ................6
Color Space, SETUP menu ..................34
Connection Setting, SETUP menu .......32
Connection Test, SETUP menu ...........33
Control buttons, remote control .............8
Country Code, SETUP menu ...............32
Cursor buttons, remote control ..............8
■
Additional information
A/B, remote control ...............................7
Angle Mark, SETUP menu ..................32
Angle, On Screen menu .......................24
ANGLE, remote control ........................7
Audio connection .................................14
Audio file requirement ...........................3
Audio output formats ...........................36
Audio Output, SETUP menu ...............35
Audio Setting, SETUP menu ...............35
Audio, On Screen menu .......................24
AUDIO, remote control .........................7
Audio, SETUP menu ...........................32
■
Precaución: lea las indicaciones siguientes antes de
utilizar este aparato.
1
2
3
4
5
Para asegurar el mejor rendimiento de este aparato, lea
atentamente este manual. Y luego guárdelo en un lugar
seguro para poder consultarlo en el futuro en caso de ser
necesario.
Instale esta unidad en un lugar bien ventilado, fresco, seco y
limpio, alejado de la luz directa del sol, fuentes de calor,
vibración, polvo, humedad y/o frío. Para una adecuada
ventilación, permita que el equipo tenga el siguiente espacio
libre mínimo:
Superior: 10 cm
Posterior: 10 cm
Laterales: 10 cm
Coloque este aparato lejos de otros aparatos eléctricos,
motores o transformadores, para evitar así los ruidos de
zumbido.
No exponga este aparato a cambios bruscos de temperaturas,
del frío al calor, ni lo coloque en lugares muy húmedos (una
habitación con deshumidificador, por ejemplo), para impedir
así que se forme condensación en su interior, lo que podría
causar una descarga eléctrica, un incendio, daños en el
aparato y/o lesiones a las personas.
Evite instalar este aparato en un lugar donde puedan caerle
encima objetos extraños y/o donde quede expuesto al goteo o
a la salpicadura de líquidos. Encima de este aparato no ponga:
– Otros componentes, porque pueden causar daños y/o
decoloración en la superficie de este aparato.
– Objetos con fuego (velas, por ejemplo), porque
pueden causar un incendio, daños en el aparato y/o
lesiones a las personas.
– Recipientes con líquidos, porque pueden caerse y
derramar el líquido, causando descargas eléctricas al
usuario y/o dañando el aparato.
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
No tape este aparato con un periódico, mantel, cortina, etc.
para no impedir el escape del calor. Si aumenta la
temperatura en el interior del aparato, esto puede causar un
incendio, daños en el aparato y/o lesiones a las personas.
No enchufe este aparato a una toma de corriente hasta
después de haber terminado todas las conexiones.
No ponga el aparato al revés. Podría recalentarse y
posiblemente causar daños.
No utilice una fuerza excesiva con los conmutadores, los
controles y/o los cables.
Cuando desconecte el cable de alimentación de la toma de
corriente, sujete la clavija y tire de ella; no tire del propio
cable.
No limpie este aparato con disolventes químicos porque
podría estropear el acabado. Utilice un paño limpio y seco
para limpiar el aparato.
Utilice solamente la tensión especificada en este aparato.
Utilizar el aparato con una tensión superior a la especificada
resulta peligroso y puede producir un incendio, daños en el
aparato y/o lesiones a las personas. Yamaha no se hará
responsable de ningún daño debido al uso de este aparato con
una tensión diferente de la especificada.
Para impedir daños debidos a relámpagos, desconecte el
cable de alimentación de la toma de corriente durante una
tormenta eléctrica.
No intente modificar ni arreglar este aparato. Póngase en
contacto con el personal de servicio Yamaha cualificado
cuando necesite realizar alguna reparación. La caja no deberá
abrirse nunca por ninguna razón.
Cuando no piense utilizar este aparato durante mucho tiempo
(cuando se ausente de casa por vacaciones, por ejemplo)
desconecte el cable de alimentación de la toma de corriente.
Precaución-i Es
16 Asegúrese de leer la sección “Resolución de problemas”
antes de dar por concluido que su aparato está averiado.
17 Antes de trasladar este aparato, pulse p para ponerlo en el
modo de espera, y luego desconecte el cable de alimentación
de CA de la toma de corriente.
18 La condensación se formará cuando cambie de repente la
temperatura ambiental. Desconecte en este caso el cable de
alimentación de la toma de corriente y no utilice el aparato.
19 El aparato se calentará cuando la utilice durante mucho
tiempo. Desconecte en este caso la alimentación y luego no
utilice el aparato para permitir que se enfríe.
20 Instale este aparato cerca de la toma de CA y donde se pueda
alcanzar fácilmente la clavija de alimentación.
21 Las baterías no deberán exponerse a un calor excesivo como,
por ejemplo, el que producen los rayos del sol, el fuego y
similares.
No utilice esta unidad a menos de 22 cm de personas
con marcapasos o implantes de desfibrilador.
Este aparato no se desconecta de la fuente de
alimentación de CA si está conectada a una toma de
corriente, aunque la propia aparato esté apagada con p.
A este estado se le llama modo de espera. En este
estado, este aparato ha sido diseñada para que consuma
un cantidad de corriente muy pequeña.
ADVERTENCIA
PARA REDUCIR EL RIESGO DE INCENDIO O
DESCARGA ELÉCTRICA, NO EXPONGA ESTE
APARATO A LA LLUVIA NI A LA HUMEDAD.
El componente láser de este producto es capaz de emitir
radiación que sobrepasa el límite establecido para la
clase 1.
Este equipo opera a titulo secundario,
consecuentemente, debe aceptar interferencias
perjudiciales incluyendo equipos de la misma clase y
puede no causar interferencias a sistemas operando a
titulo primario.
Índice general
1. Introducción
1
4. Ajustes
Qué puede hacer con este reproductor ........... 2
Piezas incluidas ................................................. 2
Información sobre discos y archivos............... 3
Tipos de discos/archivos que pueden utilizarse con este
reproductor .................................................................
Para cargar un disco........................................................
Precauciones con los discos............................................
Aviso para ver imágenes de vídeo en 3D .......................
Tecnología Cinavia.........................................................
Menú SETUP ..................................................... 28
Ejemplo de funcionamiento del menú SETUP ............. 30
Configuración General .................................................. 31
Configuración de pantalla ............................................. 33
Configuración de audio................................................. 35
Sistema de Información ................................................ 35
Acerca de los formatos de salida de audio.................... 36
Acerca de los formatos de salida de vídeo.................... 37
3
4
4
4
4
Actualización de software ............................... 38
Controles y funciones ....................................... 5
Actualización del software............................................ 38
Panel delantero ............................................................... 5
Mando a distancia........................................................... 6
Introducción a las conexiones........................ 10
Panel trasero ................................................................. 10
Conexión HDMI................................................. 12
Conexión con el terminal HDMI .................................. 12
Conexión para la reproducción de discos
Blu-ray 3D................................................................ 12
Conexiones de vídeo ....................................... 13
Conexión a la toma de vídeo componente.................... 13
Conexiones de audio ....................................... 14
Conexión con el terminal/toma de audio digital........... 14
Conexión con las tomas de audio ................................. 15
Conexión de red y USB ................................... 16
Conexión con el terminal NETWORK......................... 16
Conexión con el conector USB .................................... 16
Otras conexiones ............................................. 17
Conexión a las tomas REMOTE CONTROL............... 17
Conexión del cable de alimentación............................. 17
4
5
5. Información adicional
Alimentación................................................................. 39
Funcionamiento básico ................................................. 39
Reproducción de disco .................................................. 39
Imagen........................................................................... 40
Sonido ........................................................................... 40
Red ................................................................................ 40
Mensajes en pantalla ..................................................... 41
Glosario ............................................................. 42
Especificaciones .............................................. 43
Información general ...................................................... 43
Rendimiento de audio ................................................... 43
Entrada/salida................................................................ 43
Propiedad intelectual..................................................... 44
Índice ................................................................. 45
(al final de este manual)
Information about software ....................................i
Asistente inicial/Configuración Sencilla ........ 18
Configuración con el Asistente inicial/Configuración
Sencilla..................................................................... 18
Menú HOME/MEDIA ......................................... 18
Reproducción de fotos/música/vídeo............................ 18
Uso de contenidos de red.............................................. 20
21
21
22
23
Inicio de Netflix............................................................ 23
Funciones avanzadas de reproducción ......... 24
24
25
26
26
26
27
27
27
– Este manual describe cómo utilizar este reproductor
con un mando a distancia, excepto cuando no esté
disponible. También se puede acceder a algunas de
estas operaciones mediante los botones del panel
delantero.
– Las notas contienen información importante sobre
seguridad e instrucciones de funcionamiento. Las
indicaciones señalan consejos de funcionamiento.
– Este manual se ha impreso antes de la fabricación. El
diseño y las especificaciones están sujetos a cambios
en parte como resultado de mejoras, etc. En caso de
diferencias entre el manual y el producto, este último
tiene prioridad.
Iconos utilizados en este manual
Los iconos se utilizan para indicar botones/funciones
disponibles para un formato particular. Para obtener
información sobre los discos y formatos que se pueden
reproducir, consulte página 3.
BD : Vídeo BD
DVD : Vídeo DVD, DVD-VR, DVD+VR
CD : CD de audio
VIDEO : archivos de vídeo
MUSIC : archivos de audio
PHOTO : archivos de fotos
1 Es
Español
■ Acerca de este manual
3. Reproducción
Menú en pantalla ..........................................................
Menú de estado.............................................................
Uso de Marcador ..........................................................
Programación de la reproducción .................................
Uso de la búsqueda ......................................................
Uso de BONUSVIEW™ y BD-Live™ ........................
Utilización de la función Imagen en Imagen
(reproducción de audio/vídeo secundario) ...............
Utilización de la función BD-Live™ ...........................
3
Resolución de problemas................................ 39
2. Conexiones
Uso de servicios de red ...................................
Reproducción de vídeos de YouTube™ ........
Reproducción de fotografías desde un
álbum Web de Picasa™ ...............................
Reproducción de vídeos de Netflix™.............
2
INTRODUCCIÓN
Qué puede hacer con este reproductor
Configuración sencilla de idioma, resolución y relación de aspecto
\
de la pantalla
pág. 18
Puede ajustar la configuración de idioma y TV.
Reproducción de discos Blu-ray Disc™/Blu-ray 3D™/DVD/CD
comercializados en el mercado*
\
pág. 24
\
pág. 27
\
pág. 18
\
pág. 20
\
pág. 31
\
pág. 21
Además de los discos Blu-ray, este reproductor también admite la reproducción de otros tipos de
discos.
Reproducción de BONUSVIEW™, BD-Live™, etc.*
Puede disfrutar de más películas en los discos Blu-ray más recientes.
Reproducción de archivos de Vídeo, Música, Foto de un disco/
dispositivos de memoria USB*
Con este reproductor se pueden reproducir archivos grabados en discos/dispositivos de memoria
USB.
Reproducción de archivos de Vídeo, Música, Foto de un servidor
doméstico de red* **
El contenido del PC se puede reproducir en el televisor o el receptor de A/V conectando este
reproductor a un servidor de red.
Control con el mando a distancia del televisor, receptor de A/V,
etc.
Puede conectar dispositivos con un cable HDMI y controlarlos con un único mando a distancia
utilizando la función Control HDMI.
Transferencia de contenidos de reproducción en los servicios de
red**
Puede disfrutar instantáneamente de vídeos a través de Internet con este reproductor.
* Para obtener información sobre los discos y formatos que se pueden reproducir, consulte la página 3.
** Para utilizar esta función, es necesaria la configuración de red.
Piezas incluidas
Asegúrese de que con el producto se han suministrado los siguientes accesorios.
Mando a
distancia
2 Es
Pilas (×2)
(AAA, R03, UM-4)
Cable de audio/vídeo
Cable de alimentación
1
Información sobre discos y archivos
– En este reproductor se pueden reproducir discos de
12 cm y 8 cm. No utilice un adaptador de 8 cm a
12 cm.
– Utilice discos que sean compatibles con los
estándares que se indican con la presencia de
logotipos oficiales en la etiqueta del disco. La
reproducción de discos que no cumplan con estos
estándares no está garantizada. Además, la calidad
de imagen o sonido no está garantizada aunque
puedan reproducirse estos discos.
Tipo de soporte
Formato de grabación
BD-ROM/BD-R/
BD-RE
BD-Video/archivos de datos
DVD-ROM
DVD-Video
DVD-R/DVD-R
DL/DVD-RW
DVD-Video/DVD-VR/AVCHD/archivos de
datos
DVD+R/DVD+R
DL/DVD+RW
DVD-Video/DVD+VR/AVCHD/archivos de
datos
CD-ROM
CDDA/HDCD
Ejemplos de código de región
CDDA/archivos de datos
USB*
Archivos de datos
DLNA
Archivos de datos
Formatos de
archivo de vídeo
reproducibles
Formatos de
archivo de foto
reproducibles
VIDEO
PHOTO
DivX (.divx)
MKV con formato
DivX (.mkv)
MKV con H.264
(.mkv)
MPEG PS (.mpeg/
.mpg)
MPEG TS (.ts)
MPEG-4 (.mp4)
VOB (.vob)
AVI (.avi)
ASF (.asf)
WMV (.wmv)
DVD-Video
Código de región “1” o “ALL”
1
ALL
JPEG (.jpeg/.jpg)
GIF (.gif)
PNG (.png)
Notas
– No se garantiza la reproducción de los archivos
incluidos en la tabla anterior en función del método
utilizado para la creación del archivo o del códec
empleado.
– No pueden reproducirse los archivos con protección
de los derechos de autor.
– Al utilizar DLNA, el archivo debe cumplir los
requisitos del servidor DLNA.
– Las operaciones y funciones de vídeo Blu-ray Disc/
DVD pueden ser diferentes de las explicaciones que
aparecen en este manual y algunas operaciones
pueden estar prohibidas debido a las configuraciones
del fabricante del disco.
– Si aparece una pantalla de menú o instrucciones de
funcionamiento durante la reproducción de un disco,
siga el procedimiento de funcionamiento indicado.
– Según el disco, puede que no sea posible su
reproducción.
– Finalice todos los soportes de grabación que desee
reproducir en este reproductor.
– “Finalizar” hace referencia a un procesamiento al
que se somete un disco grabado para que se pueda
reproducir en otros reproductores/grabadores, así
como en este reproductor. Solo pueden reproducirse
en el reproductor los discos que se hayan finalizado.
(Este reproductor no dispone de una función para
finalizar discos.)
– No se garantiza la reproducción de todos los archivos
de un disco, dispositivo de memoria USB y de la red.
– Un archivo con protección de los derechos de autor
no se puede reproducir a través de un dispositivo de
memoria USB o red.
Requisitos de los archivos de audio
– Frecuencia de muestreo: entre 32 - 48 kHz (MP3/
WMA), LPCM 44,1 kHz/16 bits/estéreo (WAV),
192 kHz/24 bits (FLAC)
– Bitrate: entre 8 - 320 kbps (MP3), 32 - 192 kbps
(WMA)
Requisitos de los archivos WMV
– WMV9; la resolución máxima es de 1.920 × 1.080.
3 Es
Español
MP3 (.mp3)
WMA (.wma)
AAC (.aac/.m4a)
WAV (.wav)
FLAC (.flac)
Código de región “A” o “ABC”
Notas
* Este reproductor es compatible con un dispositivo de
memoria USB con formato FAT 16/32 y NTFS.
MUSIC
– Los discos y los reproductores de vídeo Blu-ray
Disc/DVD tienen códigos de región, que dictan las
regiones en las que se puede reproducir un disco.
Consulte la marca de código de región que aparece
en el panel trasero de este reproductor.
– En el caso de un Blu-ray Disc, el disco puede
reproducirse en este reproductor si tiene la misma
marca de código de región o bien la marca “ABC”
de código de región.
– En el caso de un disco DVD, el disco puede
reproducirse en este reproductor si tiene la misma
marca de código de región o bien la marca “ALL” de
código de región.
BD-Video
CD-R/CD-RW
Formatos de
archivo de
audio
reproducibles
Información sobre la gestión de la
región en los vídeos Blu-ray Disc/DVD
Introducción
■ Tipos de discos/archivos que
pueden utilizarse con este
reproductor
Información sobre discos y archivos
■ Para cargar un disco
– Inserte el disco con la etiqueta hacia arriba.
– En el caso de un disco grabado por ambos lados,
ponga boca abajo el lado que va a reproducir.
Limpieza de la lente lectora
– No utilice nunca discos de limpieza de venta en el mercado.
La utilización de estos discos podría dañar la lente.
– Solicite la limpieza de la lente en el centro de atención al
cliente aprobado por Yamaha más cercano.
■ Aviso para ver imágenes de vídeo en 3D
Notas
– La reproducción podría iniciarse automáticamente,
dependiendo del disco y la configuración del
reproductor.
– Es posible que el menú aparezca primero, según el disco.
– El tiempo para cargar el disco puede variar
dependiendo del disco.
■ Precauciones con los discos
Tenga cuidado con los arañazos y el
polvo
– Los discos Blu-ray Disc, DVD y CD son sensibles al
polvo, a las huellas dactilares y especialmente a los
arañazos. Es posible que no se pueda reproducir un
disco con arañazos. Maneje los discos con cuidado y
guárdelos en un lugar seguro.
Almacenamiento apropiado de los
discos
Ponga el disco en el centro de la caja y
almacene la caja y el disco en posición
vertical.
Evite guardar los discos en lugares con luz
solar directa, cerca de equipos de
calefacción o en lugares con una humedad
alta.
No deje caer los discos ni los someta a
vibraciones o impactos fuertes.
Evite almacenar los discos en lugares
donde haya mucha cantidad de polvo o
humedad.
Precauciones de manipulación
– Si la superficie está sucia, límpiela con
cuidado con un paño suave humedecido
(con agua solamente). Cuando limpie los
discos, mueva siempre el paño desde el
orificio central hacia el borde exterior.
– No utilice pulverizadores de limpieza de
discos de vinilo, benceno, diluyente,
líquidos para prevenir la electricidad
estática ni otros disolventes.
– No toque la superficie.
– No pegue papel ni etiquetas adhesivas en el disco.
– Si la superficie de reproducción de un disco está
sucia o rayada, el reproductor puede decidir que el
disco es incompatible y expulsar la bandeja
portadiscos o es posible que el disco no se
reproduzca correctamente. Limpie cualquier mancha
de la superficie de reproducción con un paño suave.
4 Es
– Algunas personas pueden sufrir molestias (como
vista cansada, fatiga o náuseas) al ver imágenes de
vídeo en 3D. Se recomienda a todos los espectadores
realizar pausas periódicas durante la visualización de
imágenes de vídeo en 3D.
– Si sufre alguna molestia, deje de ver las imágenes de
vídeo en 3D hasta que ésta desaparezca. Consulte
con un médico si sufre molestias agudas.
– Lea atentamente los manuales de instrucciones (del
Blu-ray Disc y del televisor) y los mensajes de
precaución que aparecen en el televisor.
– La vista de los niños pequeños (especialmente de
menos de seis años) todavía está en proceso de
desarrollo. Consulte con su médico (como un
pediatra o un oftalmólogo) antes de permitir a niños
pequeños ver imágenes de vídeo en 3D.
– Los niños pequeños deben estar bajo la supervisión
de un adulto para garantizar que siguen las
recomendaciones descritas anteriormente.
■ Tecnología Cinavia
– La tecnología Cinavia forma parte del sistema de
protección de los contenidos incluido en este
reproductor de Blu-ray Disc.
Nota
– Es posible que aparezcan los siguientes mensajes y
que su reproductor de Blu-ray Disc detenga la
reproducción o silencie temporalmente la salida de
audio si reproduce una copia no autorizada de un
contenido protegido mediante la tecnología Cinavia.
Estos mensajes aparecen solo en inglés.
Reproducción detenida. Los contenidos que se están
reproduciendo están protegidos por Cinavia™ y su
reproducción en este dispositivo no está autorizada.
Para más información, visite http://www.cinavia.com.
Código de Mensaje 1.
Salida de audio temporalmente detenida. No ajuste el
volumen de reproducción. Los contenidos que se están
reproduciendo están protegidos por Cinavia™ y su
reproducción en este dispositivo no está autorizada.
Para más información, visite http://www.cinavia.com.
Código de Mensaje 3.
Aviso sobre Cinavia
Este producto utiliza la tecnología Cinavia para limitar el
uso de copias no autorizadas de algunas películas y vídeos
comerciales y de sus bandas sonoras. Al detectar el uso
prohibido de una copia no autorizada, aparecerá un
mensaje y se detendrá la reproducción o la copia.
Para obtener más información sobre la tecnología Cinavia,
consulte el Centro de información al consumidor de Cinavia, que
encontrará en el sitio web http://www.cinavia.com. Para solicitar
más información sobre Cinavia por correo, envíe una carta con
su dirección de correo a: Cinavia Consumer Information Center,
P.O. Box 86851, San Diego, CA, 92138, Estados Unidos
1
Controles y funciones
Introducción
■ Panel delantero
USB
1 2
3
1 p (Encendido/en espera)
Pone en marcha el reproductor/activa el modo en
espera.
Mantenga pulsado p en el panel delantero durante más
de 5 segundos y deje de pulsarlo para reiniciar el
reproductor (se reiniciará el sistema).
4
5 6 7
4 Puerta de la bandeja portadiscos
5
(Expulsar)
Abre/cierra la bandeja portadiscos.
9
0
6
(Búsqueda hacia atrás/Salto hacia
atrás):
Pulse para saltar hacia atrás y mantenga pulsado para
buscar hacia atrás.
7
(Búsqueda hacia adelante/Salto
hacia adelante):
Pulse para saltar hacia adelante y mantenga pulsado
para buscar hacia adelante.
8
(Reproducción)
Inicia la reproducción.
9
(Pausa)
Pone la reproducción en pausa.
0
(Detener)
Detiene la reproducción.
2 Conector USB (pág. 16)
3 Visor del panel delantero
Muestra distintos tipos de información sobre el estado
del dispositivo.
8
– Una película protectora colocada en la fábrica cubre el panel delantero de este reproductor. Retírela antes de empezar
a utilizar el reproductor.
5 Es
Español
Nota
Controles y funciones
■ Mando a distancia
1 Transmisor de señales infrarrojas: Emite la
señal infrarroja. Oriente esta ventana al sensor del
mando a distancia (pág. 9).
Nota
–
aparecerá en la esquina superior izquierda de la
pantalla cuando la tecla pulsada no esté disponible.
1
2
3
4
PROGRAM
MARKER
DIGEST
ZOOM
R
G
Y
B
SUBTITLE
ANGLE
5
6
7
8
9
0
AUDIO
CLEAR
SEARCH
SHUFFLE
PIP
SETUP
REPEAT
2ND
AUDIO
HOME
A B
TOP MENU
POP-UP MENU
2 MARKER DVD VIDEO : Establece un Marcador
(pág. 26) en un punto especificado de una película.
Tras definir un Marcador, para seleccionar el punto de
ajuste al que desea ir, pulse DIGEST. Puede definir
hasta 12 marcadores.
C
3
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
4 PROGRAM DVD CD : Establece el orden de
reproducción (pág. 26). Puede configurar hasta 15 pistas
(para discos de audio) o títulos/capítulos (DVD-Video).
L
M
: Abre/cierra la bandeja portadiscos.
5 Teclas numéricas: Permiten introducir números, o
durante la reproducción, saltar a la pista/capítulo
correspondiente al número introducido. Es posible que
estos botones no estén disponibles en función del tipo
de disco y la situación de reproducción.
6 CLEAR: Borra el número introducido o elemento establecido.
7 PIP BD : Permite encender/apagar la función Imagen
en imagen (pág. 27). Marca PIP (
) se muestra en
pantalla cuando esta función está disponible. También
puede seleccionar esta opción desde el menú en
pantalla (pág. 24).
ENTER
Nota
RETURN
ON SCREEN
– Marca PIP se muestra solo cuando la Marca PIP está
activada (pág. 32).
8 SETUP: Muestra la pantalla de menú SETUP (pág. 28).
A
B
NETFLIX
STATUS
9 2ND AUDIO BD : Selecciona el audio secundario de la
función Imagen en imagen (pág. 27) o los comentarios
de audio. Cuando esta función está disponible se
muestra en pantalla Marca Audio Secundario (
)
(pág. 35). También puede seleccionar esta opción
desde el menú en pantalla (pág. 24).
Nota
– Marca Audio Secundario se muestra solo cuando la
Marca Audio Secundario está activada (pág. 32).
0 HOME: Muestra la pantalla de menú HOME (pág. 18).
A NETFLIX: Inicia Netflix (pág. 23).
B STATUS: Muestra la información de reproducción
(pág. 25).
C DIGEST PHOTO : Muestra 12 fotografías en
miniatura. Cuando se muestran las miniaturas, puede
ir a la página siguiente o anterior con
/
.
:
Muestra
la
barra
de
selección
DVD VIDEO
Marcador (pág. 26).
D p: Enciende el reproductor o lo pone en modo de espera.
E ZOOM DVD VIDEO PHOTO : Acerca/aleja la
imagen. El tamaño de la pantalla cambiará cada vez que
pulse la tecla (ampliar/reducir zoom: 3 pasos cada uno).
F Teclas de colores BD : Utilice estas teclas según
las instrucciones en pantalla.
6 Es
Controles y funciones
1
Nota
– Es posible que esta función no se pueda realizar
dependiendo de las especificaciones del disco.
H ANGLE BD DVD : Permite cambiar el ángulo de
la cámara si el vídeo se ha grabado con varios ángulos.
Cuando esta función está disponible se muestra en
pantalla Marca de Angulo (
). También puede
seleccionar esta opción desde el menú en pantalla
(pág. 24).
Introducción
G SUBTITLE BD DVD VIDEO : Permite cambiar
el idioma de los subtítulos (pág. 43) si está disponible.
También puede seleccionar esta opción desde el menú
en pantalla (pág. 24).
Nota
– Marca de Angulo se muestra solo cuando la Marca
de Angulo está activada (pág. 32).
I AUDIO BD DVD : Permite cambiar el idioma o
formato de audio. También puede seleccionar esta
opción desde el menú en pantalla (pág. 24).
J SEARCH BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC :
Permite ir a un punto especificado durante la
reproducción. Para conocer los detalles sobre esta
función, consulte “Uso de la búsqueda” (pág. 26).
También puede seleccionar esta opción desde el menú
de estado (pág. 25).
K SHUFFLE DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO : Selecciona el modo de reproducción
aleatoria (pág. 24).
L REPEAT BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
Español
PHOTO : Permite cambiar el modo de repetición. El
modo de repetición mostrado a continuación cambiará
cada vez que se pulse el botón.
: Repite el título que se está reproduciendo.
: Repite el capítulo que se está reproduciendo.
: Repite la carpeta que se está reproduciendo.
: Repite todas las pistas/archivos del disco.
: Repite la pista/archivo que se está
reproduciendo.
M A/B BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC : Permite
reproducir una parte específica que desee repetir.
1 Pulse A/B en la escena donde desee establecer el
punto inicial. Aparecerá “A-” en la pantalla.
2 Vuelva a pulsar A/B en la escena donde desee
establecer el punto final. Aparecerá “A-B” en la
pantalla. Se inicia la reproducción de la repetición.
3 Para cancelar la reproducción de la repetición, pulse
A/B. Desaparecerá “A-B” y terminará la
reproducción de la repetición.
Continúa en la página siguiente. \
7 Es
Controles y funciones
N TOP MENU BD DVD : Muestra la pantalla de
menú principal si el disco contiene un menú.
Seleccione la opción deseada mediante 5/a/2/3 y
ENTER.
PROGRAM
MARKER
DIGEST
ZOOM
R
G
Y
B
Nota
SUBTITLE
– Las operaciones concretas pueden diferir
dependiendo del disco. Siga las instrucciones de
cada pantalla de menú.
ANGLE
AUDIO
CLEAR
SEARCH
PIP
SETUP
2ND
AUDIO
HOME
TOP MENU
REPEAT
P RETURN: Permite volver al menú o pantalla anterior,
etc.
A B
POP-UP MENU
N
R
Q Teclas de control
BD
O
P
O Teclas de cursor (5/a/2/3): Permiten mover la
selección en la pantalla de menú.
ENTER: Selecciona el menú/opción resaltado.
SHUFFLE
ENTER
RETURN
ON SCREEN
S
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO
: Detiene la reproducción. Para detener totalmente
la reproducción, pulse dos veces este botón.
: Pone la reproducción en pausa.
: Reproduce el contenido.
/
Q
NETFLIX
STATUS
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC :
Permite buscar hacia atrás/hacia adelante. La
velocidad de búsqueda cambiará cada vez que pulse la
techa (buscar hacia atrás/adelante: 5 pasos cada una).
Pulse
para reanudar la reproducción normal.
PHOTO : Permite cambiar la velocidad de un pase de
diapositivas (más lento/más rápido: 3 pasos).
/
BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC :
Púlselo para realizar una búsqueda o una repetición
instantánea. La búsqueda instantánea salta
30 segundos en el contenido. La repetición instantánea
reproduce el contenido desde 10 segundos antes.
/
: Permite saltar hacia atrás/hacia adelante.
Nota
– En función del disco, el reproductor reanuda la
reproducción desde el punto en el que se paró
anteriormente el reproductor. Para reproducir desde
el principio, pulse
dos veces y después
.
R POP-UP/MENU BD DVD : Muestra el menú
emergente. Los contenidos del menú que aparecen
varían en función del disco. Encontrará más
información sobre cómo ver y controlar el menú
emergente en el manual del disco.
La pantalla del menú principal aparece a veces al
pulsar POP-UP/MENU, dependiendo del DVD.
S ON SCREEN: Muestra el menú en pantalla (pág.
24).
8 Es
Controles y funciones
Función ID
1 Configuración del mando a distancia
Para modificar el ID de ID1 a ID2, mantenga
pulsado el botón de color rojo y el botón 2 de los
botones numéricos simultáneamente durante
7 segundos. Para modificar el ID de ID2 a ID1,
mantenga pulsado el botón de color rojo y el
botón 1 de los botones numéricos simultáneamente
durante 7 segundos.
2 Configuración de la unidad principal
Mantenga pulsado
y
en el
panel delantero simultáneamente durante
2 segundos para mostrar el ID actual si:
– No hay ningún disco en el reproductor.
– La bandeja portadiscos está cerrada.
– Se detiene la reproducción.
– “NO DISC” aparece en el visor del panel
delantero.
Mantenga pulsadas las teclas durante 2 segundos
más para cambiar el ID de ID1 a ID2.
Notas
1
1
3
2
Notas
– Cambie las dos pilas cuando note que disminuye el
alcance del mando a distancia.
– Utilice pilas AAA, R03 y UM-4.
– Asegúrese de que las polaridades son las correctas.
Consulte la ilustración que encontrará en el interior
del compartimento de las pilas.
– Extraiga las pilas si no va a utilizar el mando a
distancia durante un periodo de tiempo prolongado.
– No mezcle pilas viejas con pilas nuevas.
– No utilice juntas pilas de diferentes tipos (como pilas
alcalinas y pilas de manganeso). Lea con atención la
información del paquete, ya que diferentes tipos de
pilas pueden tener la misma forma y color.
– Si observa fugas en las pilas, deséchelas
inmediatamente. Evite tocar el material derramado y
no deje que entre en contacto con ropa, etc. Limpie
con cuidado el compartimento antes de colocar pilas
nuevas.
– No mezcle las pilas con los residuos domésticos;
deséchelas siguiendo la normativa local.
– Mantenga las pilas fuera del alcance de los niños. En
caso de que se traguen una por accidente, acuda
inmediatamente a un médico.
– Si tiene previsto no utilizar el mando a distancia
durante un periodo de tiempo prolongado, extraiga
las pilas del mando a distancia.
– No cargue ni desmonte las pilas suministradas.
Alcance aproximado de
funcionamiento del mando a distancia
Sensor del mando a distancia
USB
30°
30°
6m
9 Es
Español
– Si el mando a distancia está sin pilas durante unos
minutos o si se dejan pilas agotadas en el mando a
distancia, el ID del mando a distancia se ajusta
automáticamente en ID1. Si desea utilizar el mando
a distancia con el ajuste ID2, coloque pilas nuevas y
vuelva a configurar el ID del mando a distancia.
– Cuando se reinicia este reproductor, su ID del mando
a distancia será ID1.
Instalación de las pilas en el mando a
distancia
Introducción
Puede modificar el ID del mando a distancia para evitar
una utilización no deseada de otro reproductor Yamaha,
como un reproductor de DVD. Si modifica el ID del
mando a distancia, seleccione el mismo ID para la unidad
principal. La configuración predeterminada es ID1.
CONEXIONES
Introducción a las conexiones
Encuentre el método de conexión que corresponde a su equipo de vídeo/audio. Le recomendamos que utilice el terminal
HDMI que ofrece audio y vídeo digital de alta calidad en una única conexión. Si utiliza los demás terminales/conectores,
conecte el vídeo en primer lugar. A continuación, conecte el audio.
Conecte el vídeo y audio al
receptor de A/V mediante cable
HDMI.
¿Terminal HDMI en el
receptor de A/V? *
¿Terminal HDMI en el
televisor?
Consulte el manual de
instrucciones del receptor
de A/V.
¿Terminal HDMI en el
televisor?
INICIO
Conecte el vídeo al televisor mediante cable
HDMI.
¿Utilizar receptor de A/V?
Conecte el vídeo al receptor de AV.
¿Terminal HDMI en el
televisor?
Conecte el vídeo y el audio al televisor mediante un cable HDMI.
Conecte el vídeo al televisor.
Sí
* Cuando conecte a un receptor de A/V que no pueda dar salida a la
entrada de sonido a través de su terminal HDMI, consulte el manual de
instrucciones del receptor de A/V.
No
■ Panel trasero
0
9
AC IN
VIDEO OUT
Y
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
AUDIO OUT
L
R
OUT
IN
REMOTE CONTROL
VIDEO
PR
COMPONENT
1 2 3
10 Es
OPTICAL
4
USB
5
6
7
8
2
Conexiones
Conexión de audio y vídeo al
receptor de A/V
A HDMI (pág. 12)
Conexiones de audio para el
receptor de A/V
Conexiones para vídeo
al televisor
A’ HDMI (pág. 12)
Conecte el audio al
receptor de AV.
D COAXIAL (pág. 14)
o
al receptor de A/V
E
OPTICAL (pág. 14)
B COMPONENT (pág. 13)
o
o
F L/R (pág. 15)
C VIDEO (pág. 13)
Conexiones de vídeo y audio al televisor
A’ HDMI (pág. 12)
Conexiones de audio al televisor
Conexiones de vídeo al televisor
Conecte el audio al
televisor.
D’ COAXIAL (pág. 14)
Español
o
B’ COMPONENT (pág. 13)
E’ OPTICAL (pág. 14)
o
o
C’ VIDEO (pág. 13)
F’ L/R (pág. 15)
1 VIDEO (pág. 13)
6 AUDIO OUT (L/R) (pág. 15)
2 COMPONENT (pág. 13)
7 REMOTE CONTROL (OUT/IN) (pág. 17)
3 HDMI (pág. 12)
8 AC IN (pág. 17)
4 OPTICAL (pág. 14)
9 NETWORK (pág. 16)
5 USB (pág. 16)
0 COAXIAL (pág. 14)
11 Es
Conexión HDMI
■ Conexión con el terminal HDMI
–
–
–
–
Puede disfrutar de imagen y sonido digital de alta calidad a través del terminal HDMI.
Conecte con firmeza un cable HDMI (de venta en el mercado) a los terminales HDMI.
Consulte la página 36 para obtener información sobre los formatos de salida de audio/vídeo.
Utilice cables HIGH SPEED HDMI con el logotipo HDMI (tal como se muestra en la contraportada).
¡Precaución!
No conecte el cable de alimentación del reproductor hasta haber realizado todas las
conexiones.
Este reproductor
VIDEO OUT
Y
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
VIDEO
PR
COMPONENT
OPTICAL
USB
Consejos
– Cuando utilice la función Control HDMI,
consulte “Control HDMI” (pág. 31).
– Para obtener más información sobre el modo
de salida del terminal HDMI, consulte
“HDMI” (pág. 35).
– Si no aparece la imagen, consulte “Resolución
de problemas” (pág. 40).
Al terminal HDMI
■ Conexión para la
reproducción de discos
Blu-ray 3D
Cable HDMI
(de venta en el mercado)
Para disfrutar de discos Blu-ray 3D en este
reproductor, necesita los equipos y conexiones
siguientes:
– Necesita un televisor y un receptor de A/V (si
es preciso) con funcionalidad 3D.
A’
– Todos los componentes deben estar
conectados con cables HDMI.
– El Blu-ray Disc debe contener imágenes 3D.
– Debe ajustar la opción Salida 3D de
Configuración de pantalla (pág. 33) en Auto.
A
Al terminal de entrada HDMI
HDMI IN
Receptor de A/V
12 Es
TV
Conexiones de vídeo
■ Conexión a la toma de vídeo componente
¡Precaución!
2
Conexiones
– Puede disfrutar de una reproducción de color precisa y de imágenes de alta calidad a través de las tomas de
componente.
– Conecte con firmeza un cable de vídeo componente (vendido en comercios) o un cable de clavijas de vídeo a la
toma COMPONENT/toma de VIDEO.
– Consulte la página 37 para obtener información sobre los formatos de salida de vídeo.
No conecte el cable de alimentación del reproductor hasta haber realizado todas las
conexiones.
Este reproductor
VIDEO OUT
Y
Este reproductor
VIDEO OUT
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
Y
HDMI
PB
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
NETWORK
PR
VIDEO
COMPONENT
(Verde)
(Azul)
(Rojo)
OPTICAL
PR
VIDEO
COMPONENT
USB
OPTICAL
A la toma
COMPONENT
USB
(Amarillo)
A la toma
VIDEO
Cable de vídeo componente
(de venta en el comercio)
B’
C
C’
A la toma de
entrada de vídeo
A las tomas de entrada
de componente
COMPONENT IN
(Amarillo)
(Amarillo)
(Amarillo)
Y
(Verde)
PB
(Azul)
(Verde)
PR
(Rojo)
(Verde)
(Azul)
(Azul)
(Rojo)
(Rojo)
VIDEO
AV INPUT
Receptor de A/V
TV
Receptor de A/V
TV
Notas
– Si reproduce la imagen mediante una videograbadora, la imagen puede deteriorarse debido a la función de
protección contra la copia.
– Para disfrutar de discos Blu-ray 3D en este reproductor, necesita conectar un receptor de A/V, un televisor y este
reproductor con cables HDMI. Consulte la página 12.
13 Es
Español
B
Cable de audio/vídeo
(suministrado)
Conexiones de audio
■ Conexión con el terminal/toma de audio digital
– Puede conectar el equipo de audio o el televisor en la toma COAXIAL o el terminal OPTICAL.
– Conecte con firmeza un cable de audio digital coaxial (de venta en el comercio) o un cable óptico (de venta en el
comercio) a la toma de audio digital coaxial o al terminal de audio digital óptico.
– Consulte la información sobre los formatos de salida de audio en la página 36.
¡Precaución!
No conecte el cable de alimentación del reproductor hasta haber realizado todas las
conexiones.
Este reproductor
Este reproductor
VIDEO OUT
Y
PB
VIDEO OUT
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
Y
HDMI
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
NETWORK
AUDIO OUT
L
R
PR
VIDEO
COMPONENT
OPTICAL
PR
VIDEO
COMPONENT
USB
OPTICAL
USB
A la toma
COAXIAL
Al terminal
OPTICAL
Cable de audio digital coaxial
(de venta en el mercado)
D
D’
A la toma de
entrada coaxial
Receptor de A/V
Cable óptico
(de venta en el mercado)
E
E’
Al terminal de
entrada óptica
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
AV INPUT
DIGITAL AUDIO IN
TV
Receptor de A/V
TV
Consejo
– Para más información sobre el modo de salida de la toma COAXIAL/terminal OPTICAL, consulte la sección
“Coaxial / Optica” (pág. 35).
14 Es
Conexiones de audio
■ Conexión con las tomas de audio
– Puede conectar el equipo de audio o el televisor en las tomas AUDIO OUT L/R.
– Conecte con firmeza un cable de audio/vídeo (suministrado) al terminal AUDIO OUT L/R.
– Consulte la información sobre los formatos de salida de audio en la página 36.
2
¡Precaución!
Este reproductor
Conexiones
No conecte el cable de alimentación del reproductor hasta haber realizado todas las
conexiones.
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
DMI
NETWORK
AUDIO OUT
OUT
L
R
IN
REMOTE CONTROL
USB
(Rojo)
A la toma AUDIO
OUT L/R
(Blanco)
OPTICAL
Cable de audio/vídeo
(suministrado)
F
F’
Español
A la toma de entrada
de audio L/R
(Blanco) (Rojo)
Receptor de A/V
R
AUDIO IN
(Rojo)
L
(Blanco)
(Rojo)
(Blanco)
AUDIO
TV
15 Es
Conexión de red y USB
■ Conexión con el terminal NETWORK
– El contenido del PC se puede reproducir conectando este reproductor a la red.
– Puede disfrutar de un amplio abanico de contenidos con funciones interactivas mediante la conexión a Internet
cuando reproduzca discos compatibles BD-Live. Consulte la página 27 para obtener más información sobre las
funciones de BD-Live.
Notas
–
–
–
–
–
Conecte con firmeza un cable de red (de venta en el mercado) al terminal NETWORK.
Utilice solo un cable de red STP (par trenzado blindado).
Cuando utilice Internet, necesitará una conexión a Internet de banda ancha como se muestra más abajo.
Conecte el otro conector del cable de red al nodo/enrutador de banda ancha.
Cuando utilice una conexión a Internet de banda ancha, es necesario un contrato con un proveedor de servicios de
Internet. Para más información, póngase en contacto con su proveedor de servicios de Internet más cercano.
– Consulte el manual de instrucciones de su equipo, ya que el equipo conectado y el método de conexión pueden
variar dependiendo de su entorno de Internet.
– Emplee un cable de red/enrutador compatible con 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX.
■ Conexión con el conector USB
– Puede conectar un dispositivo de memoria USB para Almacenamiento Local al conector USB del panel posterior (o
delantero) del reproductor para guardar los datos BD-Live o para actualizar el software de este reproductor.
– Conecte con firmeza un dispositivo de memoria USB (de venta en el mercado) al conector USB.
PRECAUCIÓN:
– No desconecte el dispositivo de memoria USB
ni desenchufe el cable de alimentación mientras
se estén realizando las operaciones de BD-Live
(pág. 27) o se esté llevando a cabo la
actualización del software.
– No utilice un cable de extensión USB cuando
conecte un dispositivo de memoria USB al
conector USB del reproductor. El uso de un
cable de extensión USB puede impedir que el
reproductor funcione correctamente.
Nota
– Yamaha no puede garantizar que los
dispositivos de memoria USB de todas las
marcas funcionen con este reproductor.
Este reproductor
VIDEO OUT
Y
PB
DIGITAL OUT
COAXIAL
HDMI
NETWORK
AUDIO OUT
L
R
VIDEO
PR
COMPONENT
OPTICAL
USB
Al conector
USB
Al terminal
NETWORK
Dispositivo de memoria USB
(de venta en el mercado)
Cable de red
(de venta en el mercado)
Consejo
– Para guardar datos de
BD-Live en el
dispositivo de memoria
USB del panel frontal,
ajuste Almacenamiento
Local en USB Frontal
(pág. 31).
Al terminal
LAN
LAN
Internet
Módem
Nodo o enrutador
de banda ancha
PC
Después de la conexión
– Para configurar el parámetro de Red manualmente, consulte “Red” (pág. 32).
– Para reproducir el contenido del PC conectado a su red, consulte “Uso de contenidos de red” (pág. 20).
16 Es
Otras conexiones
■ Conexión a las tomas REMOTE
CONTROL
¡Precaución!
No conecte el cable de alimentación del
reproductor hasta haber realizado todas
las conexiones.
– Para más detalles sobre la función SCENE, consulte
el manual de instrucciones suministrado con su
receptor de A/V Yamaha.
– Puede conectar un componente Yamaha (como, por
ejemplo, un reproductor de CD) que sea compatible
con la función SCENE a la toma REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT) de este reproductor.
2
Conexiones
– Puede transmitir y recibir las señales del mando a
distancia conectando a las tomas REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT/IN).
– Conecte con firmeza cables con mini clavija mono
de 3,5 mm (de venta en el comercio) en los
terminales REMOTE CONTROL (OUT/IN).
– Si su receptor de AV es un producto Yamaha y tiene
la capacidad de transmitir señales de control
SCENE, puede controlar el reproductor con la
función SCENE.
Consejos
■ Conexión del cable de
alimentación
– Después de realizar todas las conexiones, enchufe el
cable de alimentación suministrado a la AC IN de la
parte trasera del reproductor. A continuación
enchúfelo en una toma de CA.
Este reproductor
AC IN
RK
AUDIO OUT
L
R
OUT
IN
REMOTE CONTROL
A la entrada de CA
A la toma
REMOTE
CONTROL (OUT)
A la toma
REMOTE
CONTROL (IN)
A la toma de CA
Cable con mini clavija
mono de 3,5 mm
(de venta en el mercado)
– PARA PREVENIR EL RIESGO DE DESCARGAS
ELÉCTRICAS, NO TOQUE LAS PARTES SIN
AISLAMIENTO DE NINGÚN CABLE CUANDO
EL CABLE DE ALIMENTACIÓN ESTÉ
CONECTADO.
A la toma de
entrada del mando
a distancia
A la toma de
salida del mando
a distancia
REMOTE CONTROL IN
Componente Yamaha
REMOTE CONTROL OUT
Receptor de señales
infrarrojas o componente
Yamaha (por ejemplo, un
receptor A/V)
17 Es
Español
Nota
Cable con mini
clavija mono de
3,5 mm
(de venta en el
mercado)
REPRODUCCIÓN
Asistente inicial/Configuración Sencilla
■ Configuración con el Asistente inicial/Configuración Sencilla
Asistente inicial/Configuración Sencilla le permite configurar fácilmente el idioma, la resolución y la relación de aspecto
de la pantalla. La pantalla del Asistente inicial aparece la primera vez que enciende este reproductor después de
comprarlo. La misma configuración se puede realizar desde el menú SETUP = Sistema = Configuración Sencilla.
1 Cuando aparezca la pantalla Configuración Sencilla,
pulse ENTER para empezar con la Configuración
Sencilla.
2 Configure el idioma, la resolución y la relación de
aspecto de la pantalla siguiendo los mensajes que
aparecen en pantalla.
Notas
– Si no aparece la imagen tras completar Asistente
inicial/Configuración Sencilla, consulte “Resolución
de problemas” (pág. 40).
– Aparecerá un mensaje de advertencia acerca de la
reproducción de vídeo en 3D al encender este
reproductor. Pulse ENTER para descartar el
mensaje o CLEAR para desactivarlo (pág. 31).
Menú HOME/MEDIA
Los menús HOME y MEDIA le permiten examinar y reproducir archivos multimedia guardados en discos de datos,
dispositivos de memoria USB y en su red.
Nota
Iconos sobre el menú MEDIA
– Para obtener información sobre los discos y formatos
que se pueden reproducir, consulte la página 3.
: Reproduce el disco que hay en la bandeja o muestra
el contenido del disco de datos.
: Muestra el contenido del dispositivo de memoria
USB conectado al conector USB.
: Busca un servidor DLNA (pág. 20) en la red.
: Muestra el contenido del servidor DLNA conectado.
■ Reproducción de fotos/música/
vídeo
Funcionamiento básico
2/3/5/a: Mueve la selección.
2: Vuelve a la carpeta principal.
HOME: Permite entrar/salir de la pantalla de menú
HOME.
ENTER: Confirma la carpeta/archivo.
PIP
SETUP
2ND
AUDIO
HOME
TOP MENU
REPEAT
A B
POP-UP MENU
ENTER
RETURN
18 Es
ON SCREEN
Menú HOME/MEDIA
Operaciones comunes para la
reproducción de archivos en una
carpeta seleccionada
Ejemplo: Selección de un archivo de película en un
dispositivo de memoria USB
4 Seleccione la carpeta de Foto, Música, Vídeo o
AVCHD que desea reproducir y, a continuación, pulse
ENTER.
Para volver a la carpeta principal, pulse 2 o seleccione
.
Nota
3
Reproducción
– Detenga la reproducción del vídeo antes de
desplazarse a la pantalla del menú MEDIA.
1 Pulse HOME para ir a la pantalla del menú HOME.
Nota
Consejo
– La pantalla del menú HOME puede variar en función
del modelo.
2 Pulse 2/3/5/a para seleccionar MEDIA y, a
continuación, pulse ENTER.
Aparece la pantalla MEDIA.
– Tenga en cuenta que en el siguiente paso solo se
mostrarán los archivos del tipo que seleccione en
este paso. Por ejemplo, si selecciona la carpeta Foto
en este paso, solo se mostrarán archivos de fotos
después de este paso. Cuando desee reproducir un
tipo de archivo que no sea de fotos, vuelva a este
paso y seleccione de nuevo el tipo de archivo.
5 Seleccione las carpetas que contienen el archivo que
desea reproducir.
Español
3 Seleccione el elemento que contiene el archivo que
desea reproducir y, a continuación, pulse ENTER.
Continúa en la página siguiente. \
19 Es
Menú HOME/MEDIA
6 Seleccione el archivo que desea reproducir y, a
continuación, pulse ENTER.
Si selecciona un archivo de vídeo, se inicia la
reproducción.
Si selecciona un archivo de música, se muestra la
pantalla de estado y se inicia la reproducción.
Si selecciona un archivo de fotos, se inicia el pase de
diapositivas.
■ Uso de contenidos de red
Este reproductor cuenta con la certificación DLNA
(pág. 42). Puede administrar fotos, música y vídeos
almacenados en servidores DLNA de su red doméstica.
Reproducción de contenido
compartido
1 Para reproducir archivos guardados en su PC, instale
un software de servidor DLNA como, por ejemplo,
Windows Media Player 12 y comparta los archivos que
desee reproducir.
2 Encienda el PC con el software de servidor DLNA
instalado o el dispositivo DLNA conectado a su red
doméstica.
3 Pulse HOME para mostrar la pantalla del menú
HOME. Seleccione MEDIA para pasar al menú
MEDIA. Los servidores DLNA conectados a la red
aparecen en pantalla.
Consejo
– Para disfrutar del pase de diapositivas con música,
pulse HOME para volver a la pantalla del menú
HOME mientras se reproduce la música y seleccione
un archivo de fotos.
Nota
– Es posible que el archivo mostrado no se reproduzca
dependiendo del contenido.
Operaciones para la visualización de
fotos
Durante la visualización de fotos, los botones del mando a
distancia funcionan como se indica a continuación.
: Detiene el pase de diapositivas y vuelve al explorador
de archivos.
: Establece una pausa en un pase de diapositivas.
: Reproduce un pase de diapositivas.
: Pasa a la fotografía siguiente.
: Pasa a la fotografía anterior.
: Aumenta la velocidad de un pase de diapositivas en
3 pasos.
: Reduce la velocidad de un pase de diapositivas en 3
pasos.
5: Invierte una foto.
a: Muestra la foto reflejada.
2: Gira una foto en sentido contrario a las agujas del
reloj.
3: Gira una foto en el sentido de las agujas del reloj.
ZOOM: Amplía/reduce una foto (ampliar/reducir zoom: 3
pasos cada uno).
5/a/2/3: Permite desplazarse en modo de zoom
cuando la foto es mayor que la pantalla.
DIGEST: Cambia a modo de miniaturas (pág. 6). Cuando
se muestran las miniaturas, puede ir a la página siguiente o
anterior con
/
.
20 Es
Notas
– Si su servidor DLNA no aparece en la lista,
seleccione Buscar DLNA para buscarlo.
– Dependiendo del servidor DLNA, es posible que sea
necesario autorizar al reproductor desde el servidor.
– Para reproducir el archivo guardado en el servidor
DLNA, el reproductor y el servidor deben estar
conectados al mismo punto de acceso.
– Es posible que los requisitos de archivo no siempre
sean compatibles. Puede haber algunas restricciones
dependiendo de las características de los archivos y
de la capacidad del servidor DLNA.
4 Seleccione el archivo que desee reproducir.
Notas
– La calidad de funcionamiento y reproducción podría
verse afectada por las condiciones de la red
doméstica.
– Es posible que los archivos de soportes extraíbles
como dispositivos de memoria USB o unidades de
DVD del servidor de soportes no se compartan
correctamente.
Uso de servicios de red
Puede ver al instante los vídeos que ofrecen los servicios de red siguientes.
– YouTube
– Picasa (pág. 22)
– Netflix (pág. 23)
3
Notas
Reproducción
– El acceso a contenidos suministrados por terceros requiere una conexión a Internet de alta velocidad y, a veces,
también un registro de cuenta y una suscripción de pago.
– Los servicios de contenidos de terceros pueden modificarse, suspenderse, interrumpirse o dejar de proporcionarse
en cualquier momento sin previo aviso, y Yamaha no asume ninguna responsabilidad en este sentido.
– Es posible que parte de los contenidos solo estén disponibles en algunos países y que se presenten en idiomas
específicos.
– Yamaha no garantiza que los servicios de contenidos se seguirán proporcionando ni estarán disponibles durante un
periodo de tiempo concreto y rechaza cualquier garantía de este tipo, ya sea expresa o implícita.
Reproducción de vídeos de YouTube™
Puede ver películas de YouTube a través de Internet mediante este reproductor.
Los servicios pueden modificarse sin previo aviso.
1 Pulse HOME para mostrar la pantalla del menú
HOME.
Español
Consejo
– La pantalla del menú HOME puede variar en función
del modelo.
2 Pulse 2/3/5/a para seleccionar YouTube y, a
continuación, pulse ENTER.
Consejo
– Para salir de YouTube, pulse RETURN.
21 Es
Reproducción de fotografías desde un álbum Web de Picasa™
Puede ver fotografías desde un álbum Web de Picasa en Internet con este reproductor.
El servicio puede modificarse sin previo aviso.
1 Registre su nombre de usuario y contraseña en el
ordenador antes de utilizar el álbum Web de Picasa.
2 Pulse HOME para mostrar la pantalla del menú
HOME.
Pulse 2/3/5/a para seleccionar Picasa y, a
continuación, pulse ENTER.
Consejo
– La pantalla del menú HOME puede variar en función
del modelo.
3 Cuando acceda a Picasa desde este reproductor por
primera vez, seleccione el icono Nuevo usuario e
introduzca su nombre de usuario y contraseña.
Consejo
– Para salir de Picasa, pulse RETURN.
22 Es
Reproducción de vídeos de Netflix™
Puede ver películas y episodios de series de televisión al instante desde Netflix a través de Internet mediante este
reproductor. Para hacerse miembro de Netflix, vaya a www.netflix.com.
Netflix está disponible en algunos países. Se requiere suscripción ilimitada.
Consulte más información en www.netflix.com.
3
■ Inicio de Netflix
Reproducción
1 Pulse HOME para mostrar la pantalla del menú
HOME.
Pulse 2/3/5/a para seleccionar NETFLIX y, a
continuación, pulse ENTER.
También puede pulsar NETFLIX en el mando a
distancia para iniciar Netflix.
Consejos
– La pantalla del menú HOME puede variar en función
del modelo.
– Para volver a la pantalla del menú HOME, pulse
RETURN.
Notas
Español
– Cuando se requiere una actualización de software,
aparece un aviso de actualización al seleccionar
Netflix. En este caso, lleve a cabo la actualización de
software.
– Para obtener más información sobre Netflix, vaya al
sitio web de Netflix en www.netflix.com .
– Para desactivar Netflix, consulte la sección
“Información Netflix” (pág. 32).
23 Es
Funciones avanzadas de reproducción
En este capítulo se explica la reproducción de discos
Blu-ray, DVD y CD de venta en el mercado, así como
discos DVD-RW/R grabados.
Nota
– Para conocer las funciones básicas de reproducción,
consulte la página 6.
■ Menú en pantalla
DVD
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Normal
Shuffle CH (capítulo)
Shuffle TT (título)
Shuffle All
Aleatorio CH (capítulo)
Aleatorio TT (título)
Aleatorio All
VIDEO
Para mostrar el menú en pantalla, pulse ON SCREEN. A
continuación, pulse 5/a/2/3 para seleccionar una
opción y, después, pulse ENTER para utilizar la función
deseada.
MUSIC
PHOTO
– Normal
– Shuffle F (carpeta)
– Aleatorio F (carpeta)
Audio BD DVD VIDEO : Muestra el idioma/señal de
audio del Blu-ray Disc/DVD seleccionado. Puede
seleccionar el tipo de audio deseado.
Ángulo BD DVD : Muestra el número del ángulo
seleccionado en ese momento. Si el vídeo se ha grabado
con varios ángulos, puede cambiar el ángulo.
Subtítulo BD DVD VIDEO : Muestra el idioma de
los subtítulos seleccionados actualmente si hay subtítulos.
El menú en pantalla consta de las siguientes opciones.
Título BD DVD VIDEO : Muestra el número del
título que se está reproduciendo. Puede ir al título deseado
seleccionándolo desde esta opción.
Capítulo BD DVD VIDEO : Muestra el número del
capítulo que se está reproduciendo. Puede ir al capítulo
deseado seleccionándolo desde esta opción.
Pista/Archivo CD VIDEO MUSIC PHOTO :
Muestra el número de la pista o archivo que se está
reproduciendo. Puede ir a la pista o al archivo deseado
seleccionándolo desde esta opción.
Hora BD DVD CD VIDEO MUSIC : Muestra el
tiempo de reproducción. Seleccione el tipo de
visualización entre las siguientes posibilidades:
– Tiempo de reproducción transcurrido del título,
capítulo, disco, pista o archivo
– Tiempo de reproducción restante del título, capítulo,
disco, pista o archivo
Modo/Modo de reproducción
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO : Muestra el
modo de reproducción actual. Puede seleccionar uno de
los modos de reproducción siguientes:
CD
– Normal: Reproducción normal.
– Shuffle: Reproducción aleatoria sin repetición.
– Aleatorio: Reproducción aleatoria con repetición.
24 Es
Estilo subtítulos BD : Muestra el estilo de los
subtítulos seleccionados. Esta función solo está disponible
para subtítulos externos de archivo de vídeo. Puede
seleccionar el estilo de texto deseado de los subtítulos.
Bitrate BD DVD CD VIDEO
bitrate de la señal de audio/vídeo.
MUSIC : Muestra el
Video secundario BD : Activa o desactiva PIP
(pág. 6).
Audio Secundario BD : Activa o desactiva el audio
secundario (pág. 6).
Búsqueda Ins
BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC : Salta 30 segundos.
VIDEO
MUSIC : Reproduce el
Repetición Ins
BD
DVD
CD
contenido desde 10 segundos antes.
Pase de diapositivas PHOTO :
Muestra la velocidad del pase de diapositivas. Puede
seleccionar la velocidad del pase de diapositivas entre
Lento/Medio/Rápido.
Transición PHOTO : Muestra cómo aparece la foto en
la pantalla. Puede seleccionar el tipo de transición.
Code Page VIDEO : Permite seleccionar el código de
caracteres de los subtítulos que ha agregado al vídeo DivX
(pág. 42).
Funciones avanzadas de reproducción
■ Menú de estado
Muestra varios ajustes, cómo los subtítulos, el ángulo y el
número de título/capítulo/pista reproducido. Para mostrar
el menú de estado, pulse STATUS. El menú de estado
consta de los siguientes menús.
BD
DVD
CD
MUSIC
Ejemplo: Iconos cuando se reproduce un archivo de
música
123 4
5
6
7
VIDEO
Ejemplo: Iconos cuando se reproduce un Blu-ray Disc
2
1
4
3
5
Reproducción
8 7
3
6
8
1
2
1
(Estado de reproducción)
(Icono de tipo de disco/archivo de vídeo)
3
(Número de título que se reproduce): Puede
saltar al título especificado con la tecla SEARCH
(pág. 7).
4
(Número de capítulo que se reproduce):
Puede saltar al capítulo especificado con la tecla
SEARCH (pág. 7).
5
(Tiempo de reproducción transcurrido):
Puede saltar al punto especificado con la tecla
SEARCH (pág. 7).
6
7
8
(Subtítulos seleccionados actualmente):
Puede cambiar el idioma de los subtítulos con la tecla
SUBTITLE.
(Audio seleccionado actualmente): Puede
cambiar el formato o idioma de audio con la tecla
AUDIO.
3
(Modo repetición): Muestra el modo repetición
actual (pág. 7).
(Icono de tipo de disco/archivo de música)
4 (Gráficos) MUSIC : Muestra gráficos si están
contenidos en el archivo.
5
(Número de pista/archivo que se
reproduce): Puede saltar a la pista especificada con
la tecla SEARCH (pág. 7).
6 (Información) MUSIC : Muestra información
musical si está contenida en el archivo.
7
(Tiempo de reproducción transcurrido):
Puede saltar al punto especificado con la tecla
SEARCH (pág. 7).
8 (Barra de progreso) MUSIC : Muestra el estado de
progreso de la canción actual.
PHOTO
(Modo repetición): Muestra el modo repetición
actual (pág. 7).
1
(Estado de reproducción)
2
(Icono de archivo de fotos)
3
(Número del archivo mostrado)
4
(Modo repetición): Muestra el modo repetición
actual (pág. 7).
5 (Velocidad de pase de diapositivas)
25 Es
Español
2
(Estado de reproducción)
Funciones avanzadas de reproducción
■ Uso de Marcador
DVD
VIDEO
Le permite establecer un Marcador en un punto
especificado del vídeo. Después de establecer el
Marcador, puede ir al punto elegido utilizando esta
función. Puede definir hasta 12 marcadores.
1 Pulse MARKER durante la reproducción de la película
para definir un Marcador. Se muestran el número de
Marcador y el estado.
2 Pulse ENTER para programar el orden de
reproducción.
En un disco de audio, pulse 5/a para seleccionar una
pista y, a continuación, pulse ENTER.
En un disco DVD de vídeo, seleccione un título
(indicado con TT) y un capítulo (indicado con CH) en
lugar de una pista.
Para borrar una pista configurada, seleccione la pista
que desea borrar y, a continuación, pulse CLEAR.
Pulse RETURN para cancelar la reproducción del
programa.
2 Después de establecer el Marcador, pulse DIGEST
para mostrar la barra de selección de Marcador.
3 Pulse 2/3 para seleccionar el Marcador que desee
reproducir y, a continuación, pulse ENTER.
Pulse CLEAR para eliminar el Marcador seleccionado.
Nota
– Cuando finaliza la reproducción (por ejemplo, al
expulsar el disco o al presionar
dos veces), los
marcadores se eliminan automáticamente.
■ Programación de la
reproducción DVD CD
Esta opción le permite programar el orden de
reproducción de las pistas de un disco de audio o de los
capítulos de un DVD.
Pulse PROGRAMA durante la reproducción para mostrar
la ventana PROGRAMA para programar el orden de
reproducción.
Puede programar hasta 15 pistas/capítulos.
Ejemplo: Programación del orden de reproducción de
pistas de CD
1 Pulse PROGRAMA durante la reproducción.
3 Una vez finalizada la programación, pulse
para
definir e iniciar la reproducción del programa.
4 Para cancelar la reproducción del programa, detenga la
reproducción por completo pulsando
dos veces.
■ Uso de la búsqueda
BD
DVD
CD
VIDEO
MUSIC
PHOTO
Esta opción le permite ir a un punto específico durante la
reproducción.
1 Pulse SEARCH durante la reproducción. Aparece la
barra de estado.
2 Pulse 5/a/2/3 para seleccionar una de las opciones
siguientes y, a continuación, pulse ENTER.
BD DVD :
– Número de título (indicado con
)
– Número de capítulo (indicado con
)
– Tiempo de título transcurrido (indicado con
)
– Tiempo de capítulo transcurrido (indicado con
CD :
– Número de pista (indicado con
)
– Tiempo de pista transcurrido (indicado con
)
– Tiempo de disco transcurrido (indicado con
VIDEO MUSIC :
)
– Número de archivo (indicado con
)
– Tiempo de archivo transcurrido (indicado con
PHOTO :
– Número de archivo (indicado con
)
3 Pulse 5/a o los botones numéricos para definir o
ajustar el valor de la opción seleccionada y pulse
ENTER para ir al punto especificado.
4 Para cerrar la barra de estado, pulse STATUS.
26 Es
)
)
Funciones avanzadas de reproducción
■ Uso de BONUSVIEW™ y
BD-Live™
■ Utilización de la función BD-Live™
Este reproductor admite las funciones de reproducción de
BONUSVIEW (pág. 42) (BD-ROM Perfil 1 versión 1.1) y
BD-Live (pág. 42) (BD-ROM Perfil 2).
1. Ajuste la configuración de red
(pág. 32).
Nota
■ Utilización de la función Imagen
en Imagen (reproducción de
audio/vídeo secundario)
El Vídeo BD que incluye audio y vídeo secundario
compatible con Imagen en Imagen se puede reproducir
con audio y vídeo secundario simultáneamente como un
vídeo pequeño en la esquina.
Vídeo principal
Vídeo secundario
Los datos de BD-Live se guardan en un dispositivo
de memoria USB conectado a este reproductor. Para
disfrutar de estas funciones, conecte un dispositivo
de memoria USB compatible con USB 2.0 de alta
velocidad (480 Mbit/s) al conector USB
seleccionado en Almacenamiento Local (pág. 31).
La configuración predeterminada es el conector USB
del panel trasero.
– La carpeta BUDA se crea automáticamente en el
dispositivo de memoria USB cuando es necesario.
– Si el espacio de almacenamiento es insuficiente, los
datos no se copiarán/descargarán. Elimine datos
innecesarios o utilice otro dispositivo de memoria USB.
– La carga de los datos (lectura/escritura) puede llevar
un tiempo.
3
Reproducción
– Las funciones y el método de reproducción varían
según el disco. Siga las indicaciones del disco o del
manual de usuario suministrado.
2. Conecte el dispositivo de memoria
USB al reproductor (pág. 16).
Notas
Mientras se muestra Marca PIP (
)o
Marca Audio Secundario (
), pulse
PIP para activar o desactivar la
función Imagen en imagen.
– Para escuchar audio secundario, asegúrese de que el
ajuste Salida de audio (Coaxial / Optica o HDMI) se
ha definido en PCM o Recodificar (pág. 35).
– Dependiendo del disco, para escuchar audio
secundario, es posible que tenga que activar el audio
secundario desde el menú principal del disco
(pág. 8).
– Dependiendo del contenido, el audio y el vídeo
secundario para Imagen en Imagen pueden
reproducirse y desaparecer automáticamente.
Además, puede haber restricciones con respecto a las
áreas que pueden reproducirse.
3. Reproduzca el disco.
4. Ejecute BD-Live siguiendo las
instrucciones del disco.
Notas
– En relación con el método de reproducción de
contenidos BD-Live, etc., lleve a cabo las
operaciones de acuerdo con las instrucciones del
manual del Blu-ray Disc.
– Para disfrutar de las funciones de BD-Live, realice la
conexión de red (pág. 16) y los ajustes de Red
(pág. 32).
– Consulte el apartado “Conexión BD-Live” (pág. 33)
para obtener información sobre la configuración para
restringir el acceso a contenidos BD-Live.
– El tiempo que se necesita para descargar los programas
ofrecidos al dispositivo de memoria USB conectado a
este reproductor depende de las velocidades de conexión
a Internet y del volumen de datos de los programas.
– Es posible que los programas BD-Live suministrados
a través de Internet no puedan mostrar la conexión
dependiendo del estado (actualización) del proveedor.
En este caso, extraiga el disco y vuelva a intentarlo.
– Si la pantalla BD-Live no aparece durante un rato
después de seleccionar la función BD-Live en el
menú del Blu-ray Disc, es posible que el dispositivo
de memoria USB no tenga suficiente espacio libre.
En este caso, expulse el disco del reproductor y, a
continuación, borre los datos del dispositivo de
memoria USB utilizando el menú “Formato” de
“Almacenamiento Local” (pág. 31).
27 Es
Español
Notas
– Yamaha no puede garantizar que los dispositivos de
memoria USB de todas las marcas funcionen con
este reproductor.
– No utilice un cable de extensión USB cuando conecte
un dispositivo de memoria USB al conector USB del
reproductor. El uso de un cable de extensión USB puede
impedir que el reproductor funcione correctamente.
AJUSTES
Menú SETUP
El menú SETUP permite realizar diversos ajustes y configuraciones audiovisuales en las funciones utilizando el mando a
distancia.
Menú/submenú
Sistema
Configuración
General
Idioma
Reproducción
Seguridad
Red
28 Es
Opción
Función
Página
Protector de pantalla
Activa/desactiva el protector de pantalla.
31
Reproducción
Automática Disco
Ajusta el reproductor para que inicie automáticamente la
reproducción del disco.
31
Control HDMI
Configura el reproductor para que reciba la señal de control
desde el mando a distancia de su televisor/receptor de A/V.
31
Control de Red
Activa o desactiva el control a través de Ethernet.
31
Cargar
configuracion por
defecto
Restablece todos los ajustes a los valores predeterminados,
excepto el ajuste Seguridad.
31
Actualizar
Aplica la actualización del reproductor.
31
Configuración
Sencilla
Ajusta el idioma, la resolución y la relación de aspecto de la
pantalla.
31
Almacenamiento
Local
Muestra el estado de Almacenamiento Local (pág. 31),
formatea Almacenamiento Local y selecciona el conector
USB delantero o posterior de Almacenamiento Local.
31
Mensaje
Reproducción 3D
Muestra un mensaje de advertencia acerca de la reproducción
de vídeo en 3D al encender este reproductor.
31
OSD
Selecciona el idioma del menú en pantalla.
31
Menú
Permite dar prioridad al idioma del menú del disco.
31
Audio
Permite dar prioridad al idioma del audio.
32
Subtítulo
Permite dar prioridad al idioma de los subtítulos.
32
Subtítulos
Activa o desactiva los subtítulos.
32
Marca de Angulo
Permite mostrar la Marca de Angulo cuando se reproducen
Blu-ray Disc/DVD con varios ángulos.
32
Marca PIP
Permite mostrar la Marca PIP cuando se reproducen Blu-ray
Disc/DVD con Imagen en imagen.
32
Marca Audio
Secundario
Permite mostrar la Marca Audio Secundario cuando se
reproducen Blu-ray Disc/DVD con audio secundario.
32
Memoria última
Configura este reproductor para que recuerde la última
posición de reproducción de un disco cuando se pone en
modo de espera o si se abre la bandeja portadiscos.
32
DivX (R) VOD
DRM
Muestra el código de registro del vídeo DivX(R).
Información Netflix
Desactiva este reproductor de Netflix y muestra el ESN
(Número de serie electrónico).
32
Cambiar Contraseña
Permite cambiar la contraseña de Control Paterno y Código
de país.
32
Control Paterno
Establece el Control Paterno en función del contenido del
disco.
32
32
Código de país
Establece el Código de país.
32
Conexión a Internet
Permite definir la conexión a Internet en Permitir/Desactivar.
32
Configuración de
conexión
Permite definir un método de conexión de red.
Información
Muestra la pantalla de información de red.
32
33
Prueba de conexión
Realiza la prueba de conexión de red.
33
Configuración IP
Permite definir la configuración IP en Auto/Manual.
33
Conexión BD-Live
Permite definir la conexión a BD-Live en Autorizada/
Permitida Parcialmente/Prohibido.
33
DLNA
Permite definir la conexión a DLNA en Permitir/Desactivar.
33
Configuración
Proxy
Permite definir la configuración proxy.
33
Menú SETUP
Menú/submenú
Configuración de
pantalla
Procesamiento
de Video
Salida de audio
Configuración de
audio
Opción
Función
Página
Salida 3D
Selecciona vídeos en 3D o 2D.
33
Pantalla de TV
Ajusta la relación de aspecto de la pantalla del televisor
conectado y ajusta la salida de vídeo.
33
Seleccionar Salida
de Video
Selecciona la resolución de la salida de vídeo.
Sistema de TV
Permite seleccionar el Sistema de TV entre NTSC/PAL/
Multi.
34
Color Space
Permite seleccionar Color Space entre YCbCr 4:4:4/YCbCr
4:2:2/Full RGB/RGB.
34
HDMI Deep Color
Permite seleccionar HDMI Deep Color entre 30 bits/36 bits/
48 bits/Desactivar.
34
HDMI 1080p 24Hz
Ajusta HDMI 1080p 24Hz en la configuración automática o
lo desactiva.
4
34
Sincronismo de
labios
Ajusta el retardo entre vídeo y audio, como por ejemplo
cuando el movimiento de la boca no se corresponde con la
voz.
34
Ajustes
TV
34
Modo de Vídeo
Ajusta la imagen visual.
34
Ajuste de color
Ajusta Brillo/Saturación/Tonalidad para cada color.
35
Reducción de ruido
Ajusta el nivel de Reducción de ruido.
35
Modo
desentrelazado
Ajusta cómo detectar la señal de vídeo.
Coaxial / Optica
Permite seleccionar el modo de salida de la toma COAXIAL/
terminal OPTICAL
entre Bitstream/PCM/Recodificar/Desactivar.
35
HDMI
Permite seleccionar el modo de salida del terminal HDMI
entre Bitstream/PCM/Recodificar/Desactivar.
35
Downsampling
Permite seleccionar la frecuencia de submuestreo de la señal
de audio digital entre 48K/96K/192K.
35
35
DRC
Define el valor de DRC (Compresión de gama dinámica).
Ajuste de altavoz
Mezcla descendente
2 Canales
Establece la salida de audio de la toma AUDIO OUT L/R.
Postprocesamiento
Mezcla ascendente
Convierte la señal de audio de 2 canales en multicanal.
35
35
35
35
Sistema de
Información
29 Es
Español
Muestra la versión de software y la dirección MAC (pág. 42).
Menú SETUP
■ Ejemplo de funcionamiento del
menú SETUP
Debe acceder a la pantalla del menú SETUP para realizar
ajustes en el reproductor. A continuación se explican las
operaciones básicas del menú SETUP.
SUBTITLE
ANGLE
4. Introduzca la contraseña.
Introduzca la contraseña con los botones numéricos.
– La contraseña predeterminada es 0000.
– No puede ir a la siguiente pantalla de
configuración hasta que no haya introducido la
contraseña correcta.
– Para cambiar la contraseña, consulte el apartado
“Cambiar Contraseña” (pág. 32).
AUDIO
CLEAR
PIP
SEARCH
SETUP
TOP MENU
2ND
SHUFFLE
REPEAT
POP-UP MENU
ENTER
RETURN
ON SCREEN
Ejemplo: Ajuste de Control Paterno
Nota
– Algunas opciones no se pueden ajustar durante la
reproducción. En este caso, pulse dos veces
para
detener la reproducción completamente antes de
realizar el ajuste.
5. Seleccione otra opción.
Pulse 5/a para seleccionar el nivel de Control
Paterno para Blu-ray Disc/DVD y, a continuación,
pulse ENTER.
1. Muestre la pantalla del menú
SETUP.
Pulse SETUP para mostrar la pantalla del menú
SETUP.
Pulse 2/3 para seleccionar Configuración General
y, a continuación, pulse ENTER o a.
2. Seleccione un submenú.
Pulse 5/a para seleccionar Seguridad y, a
continuación, pulse ENTER o el cursor 3.
3. Seleccione una opción del menú.
Pulse 5/a para seleccionar Control Paterno y, a
continuación, pulse ENTER o el cursor 3.
30 Es
6. Salga de la pantalla del menú.
Pulse 2 para volver al menú anterior.
Menú SETUP
■ Configuración General
Los ajustes predeterminados están marcados con “
* ”.
Sistema
Protector de pantalla
Puede activar o desactivar el protector de pantalla.
Cuando se activa, el reproductor pasará al modo de
protector de pantalla si no se utiliza durante 3 minutos.
Posteriormente, el reproductor pasará al modo de espera
cuando no se utilice durante 27 minutos.
Activar*, Desactivar
Activar*, Desactivar
Control HDMI
Puede ajustar el reproductor para que reciba una señal de
control desde un televisor/receptor de A/V compatible con la
función Control HDMI a través de un cable HDMI (pág. 12).
Activar, Desactivar*
Utilización de la función Control HDMI
Con la función Control HDMI, puede controlar de
forma interactiva este reproductor con su televisor (si es
compatible con la función Control HDMI).
Cuando se conecta el reproductor a un televisor compatible
con la función Control HDMI mediante un cable HDMI y
se activa el Control HDMI en el menú SETUP (pág. 31),
pueden realizarse las funciones indicadas a continuación.
Notas
– Cuando Control de Red está habilitado, el consumo
de energía durante el modo de espera aumenta por la
función de control de red.
– Cuando está activado en Activar, se reduce el tiempo
de inicio del sistema.
Cargar configuracion por defecto
Puede restablecer todos los ajustes de este reproductor al
ajuste predefinido, excepto el ajuste Seguridad (pág. 32).
Para obtener información sobre los ajustes
predeterminados, consulte las páginas 28–35.
Actualizar
Puede actualizar el software manualmente desde
Almacenamiento USB o Red. Para obtener información
sobre la actualización de software, consulte
“Actualización de software” (pág. 38).
Configuración Sencilla
Puede realizar la Configuración Sencilla (pág. 18).
Almacenamiento Local
Puede mostrar información de Almacenamiento Local,
formatear Almacenamiento Local y seleccionar USB
Frontal/USB Trasera para guardar los datos de BD-Live.
Para formatear (vaciar) la carpeta “BUDA” en el dispositivo
de memoria USB, seleccione Información y pulse ENTER
mientras “Formato” está seleccionado en la pantalla.
4
USB Frontal, USB Trasera*
Consejo
– Almacenamiento Local se utiliza como memoria
auxiliar cuando se reproduce un Blu-ray Disc.
Mensaje Reproducción 3D
Puede activar o desactivar la visualización de un mensaje
de advertencia acerca de la reproducción de vídeo en 3D
en el televisor al encender este reproductor.
Activar*, Desactivar
Notas
Idioma
– Es posible que la función Control HDMI no
funcione correctamente dependiendo del televisor.
– Otras funciones, aparte de las que se han
mencionado anteriormente, pueden funcionar
según el televisor o receptor A/V.
– Para poder utilizar la función Control HDMI,
configure los ajustes de la función Control HDMI en
TODOS los componentes (este reproductor, el
televisor y el receptor de A/V). Es posible que
también sean necesarias determinadas operaciones.
– Cada función se puede configurar de forma independiente
para que se active o desactive según el televisor.
– Consulte los detalles relacionados con la
configuración en los manuales de funcionamiento que
se proporcionan con el televisor y/o el receptor A/V.
– Cuando está activado, el consumo de energía durante el
modo de espera aumenta por la función Control HDMI.
OSD
Puede seleccionar el idioma de pantalla, es decir, del
menú o los mensajes mostrados en pantalla como, por
ejemplo, el menú SETUP.
English, Français , Español , Deutsch , Italiano , Svenska ,
Nederlandse ,
,
Menú
Puede dar prioridad al idioma del menú del disco.
English, Français ,
, Español , Deutsch , Italiano ,
Nederlandse , Portugués, Danés, Svenska , Finlandés,
Noruego,
, Corea, Japonés, Más
31 Es
Español
• Función de selección de entrada automática
Cuando inicie la reproducción en este reproductor, el
selector de entrada del televisor (y de un receptor A/V
si este reproductor está conectado con el televisor
mediante un receptor A/V) pasará automáticamente a
este reproductor. La alimentación del televisor se
enciende automáticamente dependiendo del televisor.
• Función de apagado automático
Si apaga el televisor cuando este reproductor está en modo
de parada y no se visualiza la pantalla del menú SETUP,
este reproductor también se apagará automáticamente.
Activar, Desactivar*
Ajustes
Reproducción Automática Disco
Puede activar o desactivar la Reproducción Automática
Disco. Cuando se activa, el disco se reproducirá
automáticamente después de cargarlo.
Control de Red
Puede ajustar el control a través de Ethernet en Activar/
Desactivar. Este reproductor utiliza el protocolo Yamaha
Network Control (YNC).
Menú SETUP
Audio
Puede dar prioridad al idioma del audio para la
reproducción de Blu-ray Disc/DVD. Para obtener
información sobre la configuración de las opciones,
consulte “Menú” (pág. 31).
Subtítulo
Puede dar prioridad al idioma de los Subtítulo.
Seguridad
Cambiar Contraseña
Puede ajustar la contraseña para cambiar el nivel de
Control Paterno y el Código de país. Consulte “Control
Paterno” (pág. 32) y “Código de país” (pág. 32).
Notas
English, Français ,
, Español , Deutsch , Italiano ,
Nederlandse , Portugués, Danés, Svenska , Finlandés,
Noruego,
, Corea, Japonés, Más, Desactivar
(Los ajustes predeterminados de [Idioma] varían en
función del modelo.)
Reproducción
Subtítulos
Puede ajustar que se visualice la audiodescripción
(pág. 43) cuando se reproducen Blu-ray Disc/DVD con
audiodescripción.
Activar*, Desactivar
Marca de Angulo
Puede ajustar la visualización de la Marca de Angulo
(
) cuando se reproducen Blu-ray Disc/DVD con
varios ángulos.
Activar*, Desactivar
Marca PIP
Puede ajustar la visualización de la Marca PIP (
)
cuando se reproducen Blu-ray Disc (pág. 27) con Imagen
en imagen.
Activar*, Desactivar
Marca Audio Secundario
Puede ajustar la visualización de la Marca Audio
Secundario (
) cuando se reproducen Blu-ray Disc con
audio secundario.
Activar*, Desactivar
Memoria última
Puede configurar este reproductor para que recuerde la
última posición de reproducción de un disco cuando se
pone en modo de espera o se abre la bandeja portadiscos.
Activar*, Desactivar
Nota
– Algunos discos no son compatibles con esta función.
DivX (R) VOD DRM
Puede mostrar el código de registro del vídeo DivX(R).
Información Netflix
Puede desactivar este reproductor de Netflix y mostrar el
ESN (Número de serie electrónico). Para volver a activar
este reproductor, consulte la sección “Reproducción de
vídeos de Netflix™” (pág. 23). El ESN (Número de serie
electrónico) es un número exclusivo que permite utilizar
el servicio Netflix.
32 Es
– La contraseña predeterminada es 0000.
– Si olvida la contraseña, consulte “Resolución de
problemas” (pág. 39) y restaure todos los ajustes
predeterminados de Seguridad.
Control Paterno
En algunos discos Blu-ray Disc/DVD, existe un nivel de
control para la visualización del disco en función de la
edad del espectador. Puede ajustar el Control Paterno
mostrado en pantalla en función del contenido del disco.
Es necesario introducir la contraseña (consulte “Cambiar
Contraseña” en pág. 32) antes de ajustar los niveles de
Control Paterno.
Después de ajustar el Control Paterno, si reproduce un
disco con un nivel más alto del nivel de Control Paterno
actual o si desea cambiar el nivel de Control Paterno,
aparecerá un cuadro de diálogo solicitando que introduzca
la contraseña.
Desactivar*, 1–8
Código de país
Puede ajustar el Código de país del estado en el que vive.
Es necesario introducir la contraseña (consulte “Cambiar
Contraseña” en pág. 32) antes de ajustar el Código de país.
Este parámetro puede utilizarse para la calificación de
Control Paterno y reproducción de discos.
Red
Conexión a Internet
Ajuste esta opción en Permitir cuando utilice BD-Live (pág.
27) o DLNA (pág. 20), actualice el software desde la red (pág.
38) o use otras funciones de red.
Permitir*, Desactivar
Configuración de conexión
Permite seleccionar un método de conexión de red.
Wired*
Se conecta a la red mediante Ethernet.
Inalámbrico
Se conecta a la red mediante una conexión LAN
inalámbrica.
Permite seleccionar la configuración para una
conexión LAN inalámbrica. Siga las instrucciones en
pantalla para llevar a cabo la operación.
Scan
Busca un punto de acceso. Permite conectarse al
punto de acceso encontrado.
Manual
Permite configurar la información manualmente para
un punto de acceso.
Menú SETUP
Información
Puede mostrar la pantalla de información de red. En esta
pantalla puede ver información de Interfaz (Ethernet),
Tipo de dirección, Dirección IP, Máscara de subred,
Default Gateway y DNS.
■ Configuración de pantalla
Prueba de conexión
Puede realizar una prueba de conexión a Internet. Si la
prueba falla, compruebe la “Configuración IP” (pág. 33) y
vuelva a realizar la prueba.
Salida 3D
Puede seleccionar la salida de vídeo en 3D o 2D desde
este reproductor.
Configuración IP
Puede configurar los ajustes de red.
Seleccione este valor para configurar
automáticamente los ajustes de red de este
reproductor con el servidor DHCP.
Manual
Seleccione este valor para configurar los ajustes de
red (Dirección IP, Máscara de subred, Default
Gateway y DNS) manualmente.
TV
Auto*
Este reproductor selecciona automáticamente vídeos
en 3D o 2D.
Desactivar
Este reproductor siempre selecciona vídeos en 2D.
4
Nota
– Aunque ajuste “Salida 3D” en “Auto” y reproduzca
un disco Blu-ray 3D, este reproductor selecciona
imágenes en 2D en función de la conexión y del
ajuste del televisor, etc. (pág. 12).
Permiten introducir caracteres.
– 2/3
Permiten cambiar la opción
resaltada.
– CLEAR
Permite eliminar un carácter.
16:9 Lleno
– ENTER
Permite guardar los ajustes y salir
del menú.
Selecciónelo cuando conecte el reproductor a un
televisor con pantalla 16:9. Cuando se reproduce
vídeo con una relación de aspecto 4:3, el vídeo se
muestra como aparece en la ilustración.
Conexión BD-Live
Puede definir la restricción de acceso a los contenidos de
BD-Live.
16:9 Normal* Selecciónelo cuando conecte el reproductor a un
televisor con pantalla 16:9. Cuando se reproduce
vídeo con una relación de aspecto 4:3, el vídeo se
muestra como aparece en la ilustración.
Autorizada
Permitida
Permite utilizar únicamente los discos con
Parcialmente* certificación de propietario.
4:3
Selecciónelo cuando conecte el reproductor a un
Panorámico televisor con pantalla 4:3. Cuando se reproduce
vídeo con una relación de aspecto 16:9, el vídeo se
muestra como aparece en la ilustración.
Prohibido
4:3 Buzón
Permite que todos los discos de BD-Live se conecten
a la red.
Prohíbe que todos los discos de BD-Live se conecten
a la red.
DLNA
Puede ajustar la función DLNA (pág. 42) en Permitir/
Desactivar. Cuando no utilice la función DLNA, ajústela
en Desactivar.
Selecciónelo cuando conecte el reproductor a un
televisor con pantalla 4:3. Cuando se reproduce
vídeo con una relación de aspecto 16:9, el vídeo se
muestra como aparece en la ilustración.
Tamaño de
imagen
original
En un televisor 16:9 (pantalla
panorámica)
16:9 Lleno
16:9 Normal
Permitir*, Desactivar
Configuración Proxy
Puede definir Configuración Proxy. Ajuste la opción en
Desactivar para un uso normal. Seleccione Permitir para
definir la configuración del proxy.
Permitir
Activa los ajustes del host y el puerto proxy.
Desactivar*
Desactiva el servidor proxy. Seleccione esta opción
cuando no utilice el servidor proxy.
Host Proxy
Define el host proxy.
4:3
Tamaño de
imagen
original
En un televisor 4:3
4:3 Panorámico
4:3 Buzón
Puerto proxy Define el puerto proxy.
16:9
33 Es
Español
– Teclas
numéricas
Pantalla de TV
Puede ajustar la relación de aspecto de la pantalla del
televisor conectado y configurar la salida de vídeo.
Si cambia de televisor, por ejemplo, porque ha adquirido
uno nuevo, y la relación de aspecto de la pantalla del
televisor conectado cambia, también tendrá que cambiar el
ajuste de Pantalla de TV.
Consejos
Ajustes
Auto*
Los ajustes predeterminados están marcados con “ * ”.
Menú SETUP
Seleccionar Salida de Video
Permite seleccionar la resolución de salida de vídeo entre
HDMI, COMPONENT y VIDEO. Para obtener más
información sobre los formatos de salida, consulte
“Acerca de los formatos de salida de vídeo” (pág. 37).
HDMI Deep Color
Si su televisor y/o receptor de A/V es compatible con
Deep Color (pág. 42), ajuste esta opción según su televisor
o receptor de A/V. Esta función está disponible cuando el
reproductor se conecta con un cable HDMI.
HDMI
30 bits, 36 bits, 48 bits, Desactivar*
Cuando se define en Auto, la resolución se ajusta a la
resolución máxima según el televisor conectado.
Si está ajustado en Disco Original, se utiliza la
resolución y frecuencia de vídeo original grabada en
el Blu-ray Disc o DVD que se reproduce. Puede
utilizar la función de conversión de vídeo de un
dispositivo externo.
Si se reproduce un disco que no sea Blu-ray Disc ni
DVD, la resolución y la frecuencia de vídeo
funcionarán como Auto.
Si se reproduce un Blu-ray Disc o DVD cuya
resolución y frecuencia de vídeo no son compatibles
con el televisor conectado, no se verá ninguna
imagen. En este caso, detenga la reproducción y
seleccione una opción que no sea Disco Original.
Auto*, Disco Original, 480i/576i, 480p/576p,
720p, 1080i, 1080p
COMPONENT Puede seleccionar solamente 480p/576p o 480i/576i.
480p/576p, 481i/576i*
VIDEO
Funciona igual que 480i/576i.
Notas
– Para emitir audio HD (Dolby TrueHD o DTS-HD
Master Audio) desde un terminal HDMI, configure
Seleccionar Salida de Video en Auto o un ajuste
superior a 720p.
– Si el televisor está conectado con un cable HDMI, el
ajuste predeterminado será HDMI.
– Si el televisor no está conectado con un cable HDMI,
el ajuste predeterminado será VIDEO.
Sistema de TV
Puede seleccionar el valor de Sistema de TV entre PAL,
NTSC y Multi. Ajuste el mismo valor de Sistema de TV
que su televisor. Para obtener más información sobre los
formatos de salida, consulte “Acerca de los formatos de
salida de vídeo” (pág. 37).
NTSC, PAL, Multi
(El ajuste predeterminado varía en función del modelo.)
Color Space
Puede seleccionar la salida Color Space (pág. 42) desde
HDMI. Esta función está disponible cuando el reproductor
se conecta con un cable HDMI.
YCbCr 4:4:4* Permite definir Color Space en YCbCr 4:4:4.
YCbCr 4:2:2
Permite definir Color Space en YCbCr 4:2:2.
Full RGB
Si ha configurado RGB y el blanco y negro de la
pantalla están demasiado difuminados, seleccione
esta opción. Esta opción se aplica si un componente
conectado admite el intervalo RGB 0–255.
RGB
Permite la salida de la señal de vídeo con el rango
normal de señal.
Nota
– Esta función solo está disponible en televisores que
admitan dicha función.
34 Es
HDMI 1080p 24Hz
Permite la salida de vídeo BD codificado con una velocidad
de fotogramas de 24 Hz en HDMI 1080p 24Hz. Con esta
función es posible que disfrute de una reproducción de
vídeo más fluida. Esta función está disponible si el receptor
de A/V o el televisor admiten esta función y el reproductor
está conectado con un cable HDMI. Para obtener más
información sobre los formatos de salida, consulte “Acerca
de los formatos de salida de vídeo” (pág. 37).
Auto*, Desactivar
Nota
– Este parámetro se desactiva cuando la resolución de
salida es diferente de 1080p.
Sincronismo de labios
Puede definir o ajustar la función Sincronismo de labios
(pág. 43).
Auto*
Este reproductor ajusta la función Sincronismo de
labios automáticamente.
Manual
Puede ajustar la función Sincronismo de labios
manualmente. Puede definir el retraso del audio para
contenido 2D y 3D de forma independiente.
2D
3D
Desactivar
Este reproductor no ajusta la función Sincronismo de
labios.
Procesamiento de Video
Modo de Vídeo
Puede seleccionar Modo de Vídeo más abajo.
Estándar*
La imagen es más natural y equilibrada. Este modo
es adecuado para usos normales.
Rico
La imagen es más viva e intensa.
Cine
La imagen es adecuada para ver películas en una
habitación a oscuras.
Particularizado Puede ajustar la imagen visual manualmente. Pulse
5/a para seleccionar al parámetro y, a continuación,
pulse 2/3 para ajustar la figura.
Brillo
Ajusta el brillo global de la imagen.
Saturación
Ajusta la riqueza de color de la imagen proyectada.
Tonalidad
Ajusta el tono de la imagen proyectada.
Contraste
Ajusta las áreas claras (niveles de blanco) de la
imagen.
Nitidez
Ajusta la nitidez de los elementos del vídeo.
CTI
Suaviza los bordes de las imágenes en color. De este
modo, las imágenes en color se distinguen más.
Los valores predeterminados son 0.
Menú SETUP
Ajuste de color
Ajusta los valores de Brillo/Saturación/Tonalidad para
cada color (Rojo/Verde/Azul/Amarillo/Cian/Magenta).
Para utilizar esta función, ajuste Modo de Vídeo en
Particularizado. Para obtener más información sobre la
configuración de opciones, consulte “Modo de Vídeo”
(pág. 34).
Downsampling
Puede seleccionar la frecuencia de submuestreo de la
señal de audio digital. Esta función está activa para la
salida de señal de audio desde la toma COAXIAL/
terminal OPTICAL.
48K*
La tasa de muestreo más alta de la salida PCM
digital es 48 kHz.
Los valores predeterminados son 0.
96K
Reducción de ruido
Puede configurar la Reducción de ruido a un nivel de entre
0 y 3. 0 equivale a desactivado y 3 es el nivel máximo.
La tasa de muestreo más alta de la salida PCM
digital es 96 kHz.
192K
La tasa de muestreo más alta de la salida PCM
digital es 192 kHz.
0, 1, 2*, 3
Auto*, Película, Vídeo
■ Configuración de audio
DRC
Puede activar, desactivar o poner en modo Auto el DRC
(Compresión de gama dinámica) (pág. 42). Al seleccionar
Auto, la DRC se activa automáticamente en una fuente
con información DRC en formato Dolby TrueHD. DRC
hace que los sonidos fuertes como los sonidos oclusivos se
escuchen menos y que las conversaciones sean más
audibles. Resulta útil cuando se ven películas de noche.
Desactivar, Activar, Auto*
Los ajustes predeterminados están marcados con “ * ”.
Ajuste de altavoz
Salida de audio
Mezcla descendente 2 Canales
Puede seleccionar 2 canales analógico como método de
mezcla descendente desde Estéreo o It/Dt.
Coaxial / Optica
Puede seleccionar el modo de salida de la toma
COAXIAL y del terminal OPTICAL. Para obtener más
información sobre los formatos de salida, consulte
“Acerca de los formatos de salida de audio” (pág. 36).
Bitstream
Permite la salida de la señal digital sin ningún
procesamiento. No se produce la salida del audio
secundario.
It/Dt
Seleccione este elemento si la unidad está conectada
a un descodificador Dolby Pro Logic. El sonido de
los altavoces posteriores se mezcla con el sonido
estéreo de 2 canales.
Estéreo*
Cambia la salida del canal a estéreo, con lo que
solamente se emite sonido desde los dos altavoces
frontales.
Emite PCM de 2 canales.
Recodificar*
Permite la salida de Bitstream con audio secundario.
Post-procesamiento
Desactivar
Silencia el sonido.
Mezcla ascendente
Permite convertir la señal de audio de 2 canales en
multicanal. Para realizar esta conversión, seleccione DTS
NEO:6 y, a continuación, seleccione el modo Cine o
Música.
Bitstream*, PCM, Recodificar, Desactivar
Nota
Desactivar*, DTS NEO:6
■ Sistema de Información
Se muestran la versión del software y la dirección MAC
(pág. 42).
– Para emitir audio HD (Dolby TrueHD o DTS-HD
Master Audio) desde un terminal HDMI, configure
Seleccionar Salida de Video en Auto o un ajuste
superior a 720p (pág. 34).
35 Es
Español
PCM
HDMI
Puede seleccionar el modo de salida del terminal HDMI.
Para obtener información sobre la configuración de las
opciones, consulte “Coaxial / Optica” (pág. 35). Para
obtener más información sobre los formatos de salida,
consulte “Acerca de los formatos de salida de audio”
(pág. 36).
4
Ajustes
Modo desentrelazado
Puede seleccionar cómo detectar la señal de vídeo. Ajuste
la opción en Auto para un uso normal. Cuando aparece en
la pantalla un ruido de desgarro horizontal, configure esta
opción en Película/Vídeo para eliminar el ruido.
Menú SETUP
■ Acerca de los formatos de salida de audio
Formato de origen
PCM 2
canales
PCM 5.1
canales
PCM 7.1
canales
Dolby Digital
con AS* o
SCB**
con AS* o
SCB**
DTS
PCM 5.1 canales
sin AS* o
SCB**
con AS* o
SCB**
sin AS* o
SCB**
con AS* o
SCB**
sin AS* o
SCB**
Dolby Digital
Bitstream
PCM 7.1 canales
PCM
PCM 2 canales
MIXED 2CH
Recodificar
–
Dolby Digital
2 canales
PCM 2 canales
Dolby Digital
PCM 2 canales
PCM 5.1 canales
sin AS* o
SCB**
con AS* o
SCB**
COAXIAL / ÓPTICA
Recodificar
PCM 2 canales
sin AS* o
SCB**
con AS* o
SCB**
PCM
PCM 2 canales
sin AS* o
SCB**
con AS* o
Dolby Digital SCB**
Plus
sin AS* o
SCB**
Dolby
TrueHD
HDMI
Bitstream
2 canales
Dolby Digital
PCM 2 canales
Dolby Digital
PCM 2 canales
PCM 7.1 canales
2 canales
2 canales
Dolby Digital
PCM 2 canales
2 canales
2 canales
PCM hasta 5.1
Dolby Digital Dolby Digital
canales
PCM 2
canales
Dolby Digital
2 canales
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital PCM hasta 7.1
Dolby Digital
Plus
canales
Dolby Digital
Plus
PCM 2
canales
Dolby Digital
2 canales
Dolby Digital
PCM 2
canales
Dolby Digital
2 canales
DTS
PCM 2
canales
DTS
2 canales
DTS
PCM 2
canales
DTS
2 canales
DTS
PCM 2
canales
DTS
2 canales
Dolby Digital
Dolby
TrueHD
PCM hasta 7.1
canales
DTS
PCM hasta 5.1
canales
Dolby Digital
Dolby
TrueHD
DTS
con AS* o
DTS HD High SCB**
Resolution
sin AS* o
SCB**
DTS
DTS HD High PCM hasta 7.1
Resolution
canales
DTS HD High
Resolution
con AS* o
SCB**
DTS-HD
Master Audio sin AS* o
SCB**
DTS-HD
PCM hasta 7.1
Master Audio
canales
DTS
DTS-HD
Master Audio
* “AS” es audio secundario.
** “SCB” es el sonido clic del botón, el efecto de sonido de los menús emergentes, etc.
Notas
– Si Coaxial / Optica o HDMI se define en Bitstream, no se produce la salida de audio secundario. (pág. 35)
– Para emitir audio HD (Dolby TrueHD o DTS-HD Master Audio) desde un terminal HDMI, configure Seleccionar
Salida de Video en Auto o un ajuste superior a 720p (pág. 34).
36 Es
Menú SETUP
■ Acerca de los formatos de salida de vídeo
Si Sistema de TV se define en NTSC
Seleccionar Salida de Video
Índice
Terminal de
salida
BD-Video
HDMI
con
contenido COMPONENT
1080p/24 Hz
VIDEO
BD-Video
sin contenido
1080p/24 Hz
HDMI
COMPONENT
VIDEO
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
Otros
COMPONENT
VIDEO
Auto
Disco
Original
*1
1080p 24 Hz
1080p
1080i
COMPONENT
720p
1080p 24 Hz/
1080i 60 Hz 720p 60 Hz
60 Hz *4
*2
desactivado
desactivado desactivado desactivado
*1
*3
1080p 60 Hz 1080i 60 Hz 720p 60 Hz
*2
desactivado
desactivado desactivado desactivado
*1
*3
1080p 60 Hz 1080i 60 Hz 720p 60 Hz
*2
*2
desactivado desactivado desactivado
*1
*1
1080p 60 Hz 1080i 60 Hz 720p 60 Hz
*2
*2
desactivado desactivado desactivado
VIDEO
480p/576p
480i/576i
480p/576p
480i/576i
–
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480p
480i
480p
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480i
480p/576p
480i/576i
480p/576p
480i/576i
–
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576p
576i
576p
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
576i
4
Ajustes
HDMI
DVD-Video
HDMI
Si Sistema de TV se define en PAL
Seleccionar Salida de Video
Índice
BD-Video
con
contenido
1080p/24 Hz
Terminal de
salida
HDMI
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
BD-Video
sin contenido
1080p/24 Hz
COMPONENT
DVD-Video
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
VIDEO
HDMI
COMPONENT
VIDEO
Auto
Disco
Original
*1
1080p 24 Hz
1080p
1080i
COMPONENT
720p
1080p 24 Hz/
1080i 50 Hz 720p 50 Hz
50 Hz *4
*2
desactivado
desactivado desactivado desactivado
*1
*3
1080p 50 Hz 1080i 50 Hz 720p 50 Hz
*2
desactivado
*1
*3
1080p 50 Hz 1080i 50 Hz 720p 50 Hz
*2
*2
desactivado desactivado desactivado
*1
*1
1080p 50 Hz 1080i 50 Hz 720p 50 Hz
*2
*2
desactivado desactivado desactivado
desactivado desactivado desactivado
VIDEO
*1 La resolución se ajustará a la resolución máxima admitida por el televisor conectado. Por ejemplo, si la resolución
máxima admitida por el televisor conectado es de 1080p, la resolución se ajustará en 1080p.
*2 La salida HDMI tiene prioridad y en algunos casos puede impedir la emisión de vídeo.
*3 La resolución será la del disco utilizado.
*4 Si la opción Auto está seleccionada en HDMI 1080p 24 Hz y el televisor conectado admite los contenidos a
1080p/24 Hz, la resolución de salida será 1080p/24 Hz en lugar de 1080p/50/60 Hz.
Si Sistema de TV se define en Multi
Si Sistema de TV está configurado como Multi, la salida de la señal de vídeo tiene la misma frecuencia que la fuente.
Consulte las tablas anteriores para obtener información sobre la configuración de frecuencia del televisor y la resolución
de la señal de vídeo de salida.
Notas
– El parámetro HDMI 1080p 24Hz se desactiva cuando la resolución de salida es diferente de 1080p.
– Cuando Sistema de TV se define en NTSC y la fuente de vídeo no es 60 Hz, la señal de salida de vídeo se
convierte a 60 Hz.
– Cuando Sistema de TV se define en PAL y la fuente de vídeo no es 50 Hz, la señal de salida de vídeo se convierte
a 50 Hz.
37 Es
Español
Otros
HDMI
Actualización de software
Algunos de los discos Blu-ray que acaban de salir al mercado no se pueden reproducir a menos que actualice el software
del reproductor e instale la versión más reciente. Le recomendamos la actualización para que el reproductor funcione con
el software más actual.
Para comprobar la disponibilidad de una actualización de software, visite
http://download.yamaha.com/
Nota
– No extraiga el dispositivo de memoria USB, no ponga el reproductor en modo de espera ni desenchufe el cable de
alimentación o el cable LAN mientras se lleva a cabo la actualización de software.
■ Actualización del software
1. Prepárese para la actualización de
software.
Si actualiza el software desde Almacenamiento
USB:
1 Guarde el paquete de archivos de actualización en
la carpeta correspondiente en el dispositivo de
memoria USB. Para obtener más información,
consulte el documento de procedimientos adjunto
con el paquete de archivos de actualización.
2 Conecte el dispositivo de memoria USB.
Omita el paso 2.
2. Seleccione el método de
actualización e inicie la
actualización desde el menú
SETUP.
1 Pulse SETUP para mostrar la pantalla del menú
SETUP.
2 Seleccione Configuración General = Sistema =
Actualizar.
3 Seleccione el elemento que contiene el paquete
de archivos de actualización desde
Almacenamiento USB/Red.
Si actualiza el software desde Red:
Compruebe que el reproductor está conectado a la
red.
El sistema buscará el paquete de archivos de
actualización.
3. Actualice el software siguiendo
las indicaciones de los mensajes
que aparecen en pantalla.
La actualización se ha completado. El sistema se
reiniciará.
38 Es
INFORMACIÓN ADICIONAL
Resolución de problemas
Consulte la tabla que aparece a continuación cuando el reproductor no funcione correctamente. Si el problema que tiene
no aparece en la lista siguiente o las instrucciones no le sirven de ayuda, apague este reproductor, desenchufe el cable de
alimentación y póngase en contacto con el centro de servicio o concesionario Yamaha autorizado más cercano.
■ Alimentación
Problema
Posibles causas y soluciones
No hay alimentación.
– Conecte correctamente el cable de alimentación de CA.
– Pulse p en el panel delantero para encender la alimentación.
La alimentación del reproductor está
apagada.
– La alimentación se desconectará automáticamente pasados 30 minutos seguidos de
inactividad (sin reproducción).
5
■ Funcionamiento básico
Posibles causas y soluciones
– Utilice el mando a distancia dentro de su alcance operativo. (pág. 9)
– Cambie las pilas. (pág. 9)
– Compruebe la configuración de ID de la unidad principal y el mando a distancia. El ID
del mando a distancia de la unidad principal se puede cambiar después de reiniciar la
unidad principal. En ese caso, compruebe el ID del mando a distancia de la unidad
principal y vuelva a ajustarlo si es necesario. (pág. 9)
Los botones no funcionan.
– Mantenga pulsado p en el panel delantero durante más de 5 segundos y deje de pulsarlo
para reiniciar el reproductor.
– Para reiniciar completamente el reproductor, desenchufe el cable de alimentación de la
toma de CA durante 10 segundos o más, vuelva a enchufarlo y, a continuación,
encienda el reproductor.
He olvidado la contraseña.
– Mantenga pulsado
y
en el panel delantero simultáneamente sin ningún disco
insertado y con la reproducción parada para restaurar los valores predeterminados de
todos los ajustes, incluidos los ajustes de Seguridad (pág. 32). Una vez que la
alimentación se desconecte automáticamente, pulse p para volver a activarla.
Información adicional
Problema
El mando a distancia no funciona.
■ Reproducción de disco
Posibles causas y soluciones
– Extraiga el disco y límpielo. (pág. 4)
– Asegúrese de que se ha cargado correctamente el disco (alineado en la bandeja
portadiscos y con la cara de la etiqueta hacia arriba). (pág. 4)
– Utilice un disco admitido por el reproductor. (pág. 3)
– Extraiga el disco y compruebe si es un disco admitido por el reproductor o no. (pág. 3)
– Compruebe el código de región. (pág. 3)
– Compruebe si el disco es defectuoso probando con otro disco.
– Los discos CD-R/RW, DVD+R/RW/R DL y DVD-R/RW/R DL deben estar finalizados.
(pág. 3)
El vídeo se para.
– El reproductor se parará si detecta golpes o vibraciones.
El reproductor hace un sonido de
chasquido cuando comienza la
reproducción o al cargar un disco.
– Estos sonidos no son síntoma de avería sino parte del funcionamiento normal del
reproductor.
39 Es
Español
Problema
El reproductor no puede reproducir un
disco.
Resolución de problemas
■ Imagen
Problema
Posibles causas y soluciones
No hay imagen.
– Asegúrese de que los cables están correctamente conectados. (pág. 10)
– Asegúrese de que el televisor o receptor de A/V conectado está ajustado a la entrada
correcta. (pág. 10)
– Sin ningún disco cargado o con la reproducción parada, mantenga pulsados los botones
y
del panel delantero simultáneamente para restaurar el valor predeterminado
de la resolución del vídeo.
Si sigue sin aparecer la imagen, mantenga pulsado el botón
del panel delantero
durante unos 5 segundos para activar NTSC/PAL.
– Si está ajustado en Disco Original, se emite una señal no compatible con el televisor conectado.
Cambie el ajuste para emitir una señal compatible con el televisor conectado. (pág. 34)
La pantalla se congela y los botones de
control no funcionan.
– Pulse
y, después, reinicie la reproducción.
– Desconecte la alimentación y conéctela de nuevo.
– Mantenga pulsado p en el panel delantero durante más de 5 segundos y deje de pulsarlo
para reiniciar el reproductor.
La salida de vídeo no tiene la resolución
deseada.
– Ajuste la resolución deseada. (pág. 34)
El vídeo de pantalla ancha aparece
estirado verticalmente o aparecen
bandas negras en las partes superior e
inferior de la pantalla. O el vídeo 4:3
aparece estirado horizontalmente.
– Cambie la relación de aspecto del televisor. (pág. 33)
Aparece ruido cuadrado (mosaicos) en
la pantalla.
– Es posible que aparezcan bloques en las imágenes en escenas con movimientos rápidos
debido a las características de la tecnología de compresión de imagen digital.
La pantalla de reproducción se
perturbará si se graba vídeo DVD en una
videograbadora, o se reproduce a través
de una videograbadora.
– Este reproductor cumple con la protección contra copias analógicas. Algunos discos
contienen una señal de prohibición de copia. Si intenta reproducir tales discos a través
de una videograbadora, o grabar a una videograbadora y reproducir la señal, la
protección contra copia impedirá la reproducción normal.
No se escucha el audio o las imágenes
no se reproducen adecuadamente.
– En algunos discos en los que se ha grabado contenido protegido por derechos de autor, es
posible que no se escuche el audio o que las imágenes no se reproduzcan adecuadamente.
■ Sonido
Problema
Posibles causas y soluciones
No se escucha el sonido o está
distorsionado.
– Compruebe que el cable de audio está correctamente conectado. (pág. 10)
– Suba el volumen del televisor o del receptor de A/V.
– No se escucha sonido durante el modo de reproducción fija, avance rápido y retroceso
rápido. (pág. 8)
– Es posible que el audio no se escuche dependiendo del estado de grabación del audio, por
ejemplo, si el contenido de audio grabado no es de señal de audio o es audio no estándar. (pág. 3)
Los canales de audio izquierdo y
derecho están invertidos o el sonido
solo sale por uno de ellos.
– Compruebe la conexión de audio. (pág. 10)
No se escucha el audio o las imágenes
no se reproducen adecuadamente.
– En algunos discos en los que se ha grabado contenido protegido por derechos de autor,
es posible que no se escuche el audio o que las imágenes no se reproduzcan
adecuadamente.
No se puede escuchar el tipo de audio
que se desea y/o el número de canales.
– Consulte el ajuste Salida de audio y “Acerca de los formatos de salida de audio”.
(pág. 35, pág. 36)
No se escucha el sonido de PIP (audio
secundario).
– Ajuste Coaxial / Optica o HDMI en PCM/Recodificar. (pág. 35)
– Para escuchar el audio secundario, pulse 2ND AUDIO. (pág. 6)
– Dependiendo del disco, es posible que tenga que activar el audio secundario en el menú
principal del disco (pág. 8).
■ Red
Problema
No se puede conectar a Internet.
40 Es
Posibles causas y soluciones
– Cuando se conecte a Internet seleccionando Wired en Configuración de conexión,
conecte el cable de red correctamente. (pág. 32)
– Encienda el equipo conectado como, por ejemplo, un módem o router de banda ancha.
– Conecte correctamente el módem y/o el enrutador de banda ancha.
– Si Inalámbrico está seleccionado en Configuración de conexión, y se conecta a Internet
mediante Ethernet, seleccione Wired correctamente. (pág. 32)
– Seleccione correctamente Inalámbrico en Configuración de conexión si quiere
conectarse a Internet mediante una LAN inalámbrica. (pág. 32)
Resolución de problemas
Problema
Posibles causas y soluciones
No se puede detectar el servidor DLNA.
– Verifique que este reproductor se puede conectar a la red normalmente. Consulte
“Prueba de conexión”. (pág. 33)
– Encienda el equipo conectado como, por ejemplo un router de banda ancha o el servidor.
– Asegúrese de que el reproductor y el servidor están conectados al mismo punto de acceso.
– Dependiendo del servidor DLNA, es posible que sea necesario autorizar al reproductor
desde el servidor.
– En función del servidor DLNA, es necesario modificar el ajuste del cortafuego.
No se puede reproducir el archivo del
servidor DLNA.
– Asegúrese de que el archivo se puede reproducir. (pág. 3)
– Compruebe la configuración del servidor DLNA.
– La calidad de funcionamiento y reproducción podría verse afectada por las condiciones
de la red doméstica.
No se puede conectar a Internet a través
de la LAN inalámbrica.
– Asegúrese de que el router LAN inalámbrico está encendido.
– En función de los elementos circundantes, como el material de las paredes, el estado de
recepción de ondas de radio o los obstáculos entre el reproductor y el router LAN
inalámbrico, es posible que la distancia de comunicación se acorte. Mueva el
reproductor y el router LAN inalámbrico para acercarlos entre sí.
– Los dispositivos que funcionan en la banda de frecuencias de 2,4 GHz, como los hornos
microondas, dispositivos Bluetooth o dispositivos digitales inalámbricos, pueden llegar
a interrumpir la comunicación. Aleje el reproductor de estos dispositivos o apáguelos.
– Si la conexión a Internet a través de una LAN inalámbrica sigue sin funcionar después
de probar las dos soluciones anteriores, intente conectarse a través de Ethernet
seleccionando Wired en Configuración de conexión. (pág. 32)
La red inalámbrica no se encuentra o
está distorsionada.
– Si se lleva a cabo Scan pero la red inalámbrica no se encuentra o está distorsionada,
pulse RETURN para volver a la pantalla anterior e intente ejecutar Scan de nuevo. Si el
router inalámbrico sigue sin detectarse, pulse RETURN para seleccionar Manual.
– Asegúrese de que la red inalámbrica no se distorsiona por la presencia de hornos
microondas, teléfonos DECT u otros dispositivos Wi-Fi cercanos.
– Los hornos microondas, teléfonos DECT u otros dispositivos inalámbricos cercanos
pueden interferir en la red inalámbrica. Apague estos dispositivos.
– Asegúrese de que los firewall de la red permiten el acceso de este reproductor a la
conexión inalámbrica.
– Si la red inalámbrica no funciona correctamente en su casa, intente realizar una
conexión de red con cable.
■ Mensajes en pantalla
– Los mensajes siguientes aparecerán en la pantalla del televisor si el disco que intenta reproducir no es apropiado o
la operación no es correcta.
Mensaje de error
Posibles causas y soluciones
Fichero no compatible
– El reproductor no admite el archivo. Consulte “Tipos de discos/archivos que pueden utilizarse con
este reproductor” (pág. 3).
¡Código de región erróneo!
– El disco tiene un código de región incompatible. Consulte “Información sobre la gestión de la región
en los vídeos Blu-ray Disc/DVD” (pág. 3).
La red ha fallado.
– El reproductor no se puede conectar a la red. Compruebe la conexión (pág. 16) y la configuración de la
red (pág. 32).
Red está bien, proxy ha
fallado.
– El reproductor no se puede conectar al servidor proxy. Consulte “Configuración Proxy” (pág. 33).
La conexión BD-Live está
prohibida en el menú de
SETUP.
– La conexión de BD-Live está prohibida. Consulte “Conexión BD-Live” (pág. 33).
¡La actualización ha fallado
por alguna razón!
– La actualización ha fallado. Compruebe si el archivo de actualización está dañado o es ilegible.
¡La configuración de IP no es
válida! Por favor modificar...
– La Configuración IP no es válida. Vuelva a introducir la información correcta.
41 Es
5
Español
– Verifique que este reproductor se puede conectar a Internet normalmente. Consulte
“Prueba de conexión”. (pág. 33)
– Conecte el dispositivo de memoria USB correctamente. Compruebe que el dispositivo
de memoria USB esté conectado al conector USB del reproductor. (pág. 16)
– Compruebe si el Blu-ray Disc admite BD-Live.
– Conecte el dispositivo de memoria USB con formato FAT16, FAT32 o NTFS.
– Se recomienda conectar el dispositivo de memoria USB con al menos 2 GB de espacio libre.
Si no hay suficiente espacio libre, formatee el dispositivo de memoria USB. (pág. 31)
– Consulte el manual del usuario suministrado con el disco o póngase en contacto con el
fabricante del disco.
Información adicional
No se pueden descargar contenidos
BD-Live.
Glosario
AVCHD
AVCHD es un nuevo formato (estándar) para cámaras
de vídeo de alta definición que se puede utilizar para
grabar y reproducir imágenes de alta resolución HD.
BD-Live™
BD-Live es un estándar de Blu-ray Disc que utiliza una
conexión de red y permite al reproductor conectarse a
Internet para descargar vídeos promocionales y otros
datos.
BDMV
BDMV (película en disco Blu-ray) es uno de los
formatos de aplicación utilizados en BD-ROM, que es
una de las especificaciones de Blu-ray Disc. BDMV es
un formato de grabación equivalente a DVD-Video en la
especificación DVD.
Blu-ray 3D™
Blu-ray 3D le permite ver imágenes 3D de alta
definición completa.
BONUSVIEW™
Los discos compatibles con BONUSVIEW le permiten
disfrutar simultáneamente de subcanal de vídeo para dos
pantallas, subcanal de audio y subtítulos. Aparece una
pequeña pantalla dentro de la pantalla principal durante
la reproducción (Imagen en imagen).
Buzón (LB 4:3)
Un tamaño de pantalla con barras negras en las partes
superior e inferior de la imagen para permitir la
visualización de material en pantalla ancha (16:9) en un
televisor 4:3 conectado.
Color Space
Color Space es una gama de colores que se puede
representar. RGB es un espacio de color basado en el
modelo de color RGB (rojo, verde y azul) y se utiliza
normalmente en monitores de PC. YCbCr es un espacio
de color basado en una señal de luminancia (Y) y dos
señales de diferencia de color (Cb y Cr).
Deep Color
Deep Color hace referencia al uso de varias
profundidades de color en pantallas, a partir de
profundidades de 24 bits en versiones anteriores de la
especificación HDMI. Esta profundidad de bits
adicional permite que las pantallas HDTV y otros tipos
de pantallas pasen de millones a miles de millones de
colores y eliminen la aparición de bandas de color en
pantalla para disfrutar de unas transiciones tonales
fluidas y una gradación sutil entre colores. La mayor
relación de contraste permite representar muchos más
tonos de gris entre blanco y negro. Además, Deep Color
aumenta el número de colores disponibles dentro de los
límites definidos por el espacio de color RGB o YCbCr.
DLNA
DLNA (Digital Living Network Alliance) permite
compartir de forma sencilla contenidos digitales a través
de una red doméstica, para que pueda disfrutar de
contenidos digitales almacenados en un PC con el
software del servidor DLNA instalado u otro dispositivo
compatible con DLNA con su televisor a través de este
reproductor. Para conectar este reproductor a sus
servidores DLNA se requieren algunos ajustes del
dispositivo o del servidor DLNA. Para más detalles,
consulte el software del servidor DLNA o el dispositivo
DLNA.
Dirección Mac
La dirección Mac es un valor único asignado a un
dispositivo de red para su identificación.
DivX®
DivX® es un formato de vídeo digital creado por DivX,
LLC, una división de Rovi Corporation. Este es un
dispositivo DivX Certified® oficial capaz de reproducir
vídeo DivX. Visite divx.com para obtener más
información y herramientas de software para convertir
sus archivos en vídeos DivX.
Dolby Digital
Un sistema de sonido desarrollado por Dolby
Laboratories Inc. que da un ambiente de sala de cine a la
salida de audio cuando el producto está conectado a un
amplificador o procesador Dolby Digital.
Dolby Digital Plus
Un sistema de sonido desarrollado como una extensión
de Dolby Digital. Esta tecnología de codificación de
audio es compatible con sonido envolvente de 7.1
canales.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD es una tecnología de codificación sin
pérdidas que admite hasta 8 canales de sonido
envolvente multicanal para los discos ópticos de la
próxima generación. El sonido reproducido refleja
fielmente, bit a bit, la fuente original.
DRC (Control de gama dinámica)
DRC le permite ajustar la gama entre los sonidos más
alto y más bajo (gama dinámica) para reproducir los
contenidos a un volumen intermedio. Utilícela cuando
sea difícil escuchar los diálogos o durante las horas en
que la reproducción pueda molestar a los vecinos.
DTS
Un sistema de sonido digital desarrollado por DTS, Inc.
para su uso en salas de cine.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio es una nueva
tecnología desarrollada para el formato de disco óptico
de alta definición de la próxima generación.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio es una tecnología de
compresión de audio sin pérdidas desarrollada para el
formato de disco óptico de alta definición de la próxima
generación.
42 Es
Glosario
FLAC
Sonido PCM lineal
FLAC (Free Lossless Audio Codec, Códec libre de
comprensión de audio sin pérdida) es un formato de
audio para la compresión de datos de audio sin pérdida.
Aunque el grado de compresión es inferior al de otros
formatos de audio comprimido con pérdida,
normalmente el audio es de mayor calidad.
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface, Interfaz
Multimedia de Alta Definición) es una interfaz que
admite vídeo y audio en una sola conexión digital. La
conexión HDMI lleva señales de vídeo (estándar y de
alta definición) y señales de audio multicanal a
componentes A/V como, por ejemplo, televisores
equipados con HDMI en forma digital y sin
degradación.
Panorámico (PS 4:3)
Sincronismo de labios
Sincronismo de labios, una abreviatura de “lip
synchronization”, o sincronización de labios, es un
término que hace referencia tanto a un problema
habitual como a la posibilidad de mantener
sincronizadas las señales de audio y vídeo durante la
posproducción y la transmisión. La latencia de audio y
vídeo requiere complejos ajustes por parte del usuario,
pero la versión HDMI incorpora una función de
sincronización automática de audio y vídeo que permite
a los dispositivos sincronizarse de forma automática y
precisa y sin la intervención del usuario.
Subtítulos
La audiodescripción es un tipo de subtítulos, la
diferencia entre los subtítulos y la audiodescripción es
que los primeros están diseñados para personas sin
problemas auditivos, mientras que los segundos lo están
para personas que no oyen. Los subtítulos no suelen
mostrar todo el audio.
La audiodescripción muestra efectos de sonido (por
ejemplo, “suena el teléfono” y “ruido de pasos”),
mientras que los subtítulos no lo hacen. Antes de
seleccionar este ajuste, asegúrese de que el disco
contiene información de audiodescripción.
Subtítulos
Son las líneas de texto que aparecen en la parte inferior
de la pantalla y que traducen o transcriben el diálogo.
Están grabadas en muchos discos DVD y Blu-ray.
x.v.Color
x.v.Color reproduce una gama de colores más amplia
que antes, mostrando casi todos los colores que puede
detectar el ojo humano.
■ Información general
Alimentación
[Modelos de EE. UU. y Canadá]............................ 110–240 V CA, 60 Hz
[Modelo para América Central y del Sur].........110–240 V CA, 50/60 Hz
[Modelo para Australia] .........................................110–240 V CA, 50 Hz
[Modelo para Reino Unido, Europa y Rusia]......... 110–240 V CA, 50 Hz
[Modelo para China] .............................................. 110–240 V CA, 50 Hz
[Modelo para Asia] ...........................................110–240 V CA, 50/60 Hz
Consumo (normal)................................................................................ 20 W
Consumo (en espera) .............................................................0,5 W o menos
Dimensiones (An. × Al. × Pr., incluidos salientes) ...... 435 × 86 × 257 mm
Peso ..................................................................................................... 2,8 kg
■ Rendimiento de audio
Nivel de salida de audio (1 kHz, 0 dB)
Blu-ray Disc/DVD/CD-DA.........................................................2 ± 0,3 V
Relación señal/ruido
Blu-ray Disc/DVD/CD-DA............................................................ 110 dB
Rango dinámico
Blu-ray Disc/DVD ......................................................................... 105 dB
CD-DA ........................................................................................... 100 dB
Distorsión armónica (1 kHz)
Blu-ray Disc/DVD/CD-DA............................................................0,003%
Respuesta de frecuencia
Blu-ray Disc/DVD .......................De 4 Hz a 22 kHz (muestreo a 48 kHz)
De 4 Hz a 44 kHz (muestreo a 96 kHz)
CD-DA .......................................................................... De 4 Hz a 20 kHz
■ Entrada/salida
Salida HDMI ................................................................. Conector tipo A × 1
480i/576i/480p/576p/720p/1080i/1080p/1080p@24Hz,
Compatibilidad con Deep Color, x.v. Color
Salida de vídeo componente .....................................Y: 1 Vp-p (75 ohmios)
PB, PR: 0,7 Vp-p (75 ohmios)
Salida de vídeo. ..............................................................1 Vp-p (75 ohmios)
Salida digital.......................................................... Óptica × 1, Coaxial × 1
Salida de audio analógica ............................................ Mezcla 2 canales × 1
USB ............................................................................... Conector tipo A × 2
LAN inalámbrica............................................. Estándar: IEEE 802.11 b/g/n
Rango de frecuencias: banda de 2,4 GHz
Otros equipos................................................................ Remote IN/OUT × 1
Ethernet × 1
Las especificaciones están sujetas a cambio sin previo aviso.
43 Es
Español
Especificaciones
5
Información adicional
Un tamaño de pantalla que recorta los lados de la
imagen para permitir la visualización de material de
pantalla ancha (16:9) en un televisor 4:3 conectado.
PCM lineal es un formato de grabación de señales
utilizado para CD de audio y en algunos discos DVD y
Blu-ray. El sonido de los CD de audio se graba a
44,1 kHz con 16 bits. (El sonido se graba entre 48 kHz
con 16 bits y 96 kHz con 24 bits en discos DVD y entre
48 kHz con 16 bits y 192 kHz con 24 bits en discos
Blu-ray.)
Especificaciones
■ Propiedad intelectual
– El material audio-visual puede consistir de productos
con propiedad intelectual que no se deben grabar sin
la autorización del poseedor de dicha propiedad
intelectual. Remítase a las leyes aplicables en su
país.
– Este producto contiene tecnología de protección de
copia que está protegida por patentes de los EE. UU.
y otros derechos de propiedad intelectual de Rovi
Corporation. Se prohíbe la ingeniería inversa o el
desarmado de la unidad.
– Fabricado con la licencia de Dolby Laboratories.
Dolby y el símbolo de la doble D son marcas
comerciales de Dolby Laboratories.
– Fabricado con licencia en aplicación de las patentes
de EE. UU.: 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616;
6,487,535; 7,212,872; 7,333,929; 7,392,195;
7,272,567 y otras patentes de los EE. UU. e
internacionales registradas o pendientes. DTS-HD,
el símbolo y DTS-HD y el símbolo juntos son
marcas comerciales registradas, y DTS-HD Master
Audio es una marca comercial de DTS, Inc. El
producto incluye software. © DTS, Inc. Todos los
derechos reservados.
– “Blu-ray Disc™”, “Blu-ray™”, “Blu-ray 3D™”,
“BD-Live™”, “BONUSVIEW™” y los logotipos
son marcas comerciales de la Blu-ray Disc
Association.
–
es una marca comercial de DVD Format/Logo
Licensing Corporation.
– “HDMI”, el logotipo “HDMI” y “High-Definition
Multimedia Interface” son marcas comerciales o
marcas comerciales registradas de HDMI Licensing
LLC.
– “x.v.Color” y el logotipo “x.v.Color” son marcas
comerciales de Sony Corporation.
– “AVCHD” y el logotipo “AVCHD” son marcas
comerciales de Panasonic Corporation y Sony
Corporation.
– Java y todas las marcas comerciales y logotipos
basados en Java son marcas comerciales o marcas
comerciales registradas de Sun Microsystems, Inc.
en los Estados Unidos y/o otros países.
– Este producto se otorga con licencia en aplicación de
la licencia de cartera de patentes AVC y la licencia
de cartera de patentes VC-1 para su uso personal y
no comercial por parte de un consumidor para (i)
codificar vídeo que cumpla con las normas AVC y
VC-1 (“vídeo AVC/VC-1”) y/o (ii) descodificar
vídeo AVC/VC-1 codificado por un consumidor
dedicado a una actividad personal y no comercial y/o
suministrado por un proveedor de vídeo con licencia
para proporcionar vídeo AVC/VC-1. No se otorga ni
se da por supuesta licencia alguna para cualquier
otro uso. Se puede obtener información adicional de
MPEG LA, LLC.
Consulte http://www.mpegla.com.
– Windows Media Player es una marca comercial o
una marca comercial registrada de Microsoft
Corporation en Estados Unidos y/o en otros países.
– YouTube y el logotipo YouTube, Picasa y el
logotipo Picasa son marcas comerciales de Google.
Inc.
44 Es
– Netflix y el logotipo Netflix son marcas comerciales
registradas de Netflix, Inc.
– DLNA y DLNA CERTIFIED son marcas
comerciales y/o marcas de servicio de Digital Living
Network Alliance.
– Copyright 2004-2010 Verance Corporation.
Cinavia™ es una marca comercial de Verance
Corporation. Protegida por la patente estadounidense
7.369.677 y patentes internacionales registradas y
pendientes de aprobación en virtud de la licencia de
Verance Corporation. Todos los derechos
reservados.
– El logotipo Wi-Fi CERTIFIED es una marca de
certificación de Wi-Fi Alliance.
– DivX®, DivX Certified®, DivX Plus® HD y los
logotipos asociados son marcas comerciales de Rovi
Corporation o sus filiales y se utilizan con licencia.
– DivX Certified® para reproducir vídeo DivX® y
DivX Plus® HD (H.264/.MKV) hasta 1080p HD,
incluido contenido de calidad.
ACERCA DE VÍDEO DIVX: DivX® es un formato de
vídeo digital creado por DivX, LLC, una división de
Rovi Corporation. Este es un dispositivo DivX
Certified® oficial capaz de reproducir vídeo DivX.
Visite divx.com para obtener más información y
herramientas de software para convertir sus archivos en
vídeos DivX.
ACERCA DE DIVX VIDEO-ON-DEMAND: este
dispositivo DivX Certified® debe registrarse para
reproducir películas DivX Video-on-Demand (VOD)
adquiridas. Para obtener su código de registro, localice
la sección DivX VOD en el menú de configuración de su
dispositivo. Acceda a vod.divx.com para obtener más
información sobre cómo realizar el registro.
INFORMACIÓN ADICIONAL
Índice
■
Numerics
2ND AUDIO, mando a distancia ...........6
■
A
■
B
BD-Live ...............................................27
Bitrate, menú en pantalla .....................24
Botones de colores, mando a
distancia .............................................6
Botones de control, mando a
distancia .............................................8
Botones de cursor, mando a distancia ....8
Botones numéricos, mando a
distancia .............................................6
Búsqueda Ins, menú en pantalla ..........24
■
C
DIGEST, mando a distancia ...................6
Disco de datos, reproducción ...............18
DivX (R) VOD DRM, menú SETUP ...32
DLNA, menú SETUP ...........................33
Downsampling, menú SETUP .............35
DRC, menú SETUP .............................35
■
E
ENTER, mando a distancia ....................8
ESN (Número de serie electrónico) .....32
Estado, menú ........................................25
Estilo subtítulos, menú en pantalla .......24
■
F
Función Control HDMI ........................31
Función de búsqueda ............................26
Función Imagen en Imagen ..................27
Funcionamiento del menú SETUP .......30
■
H
HDMI 1080p 24Hz, menú SETUP ......34
HDMI Deep Color, menú SETUP .......34
HDMI, conexión ..................................12
HDMI, menú SETUP ...........................35
HOME, mando a distancia .....................6
HOME, menú .......................................18
Hora, menú en pantalla ........................24
■
I
Idioma, menú SETUP ..........................31
Información Netflix, menú SETUP ......32
Información, menú SETUP ..................33
■
M
Mando a distancia ..................................6
Marca Audio Secundario, menú
SETUP .............................................32
Marca de Angulo, menú SETUP ..........32
Marca PIP, menú SETUP .....................32
Marcador ..............................................26
MARKER, mando a distancia ................6
MEDIA, menú ......................................18
Memoria última, menú SETUP ............32
Mensaje Reproducción 3D, menú
SETUP .............................................31
Menú, menú SETUP ............................31
Mezcla ascendente, menú SETUP .......35
Mezcla descendente 2 Canales, menú
SETUP .............................................35
Modo de vídeo, menú SETUP .............34
Modo desentrelazado, menú SETUP ...35
Modo/Modo de reproducción, menú en
pantalla .............................................24
■
N
Netflix ..................................................23
■
O
ON SCREEN, mando a distancia ...........8
OSD, menú SETUP ..............................31
Otras conexiones ..................................17
■
P
Pantalla de TV, menú SETUP ..............33
Pantalla, menú ..................................... 24
Pase de diapositivas, menú en
pantalla ............................................ 24
PIP, mando a distancia .......................... 6
Pista/Archivo, menú en pantalla .......... 24
POP UP/MENU, mando a distancia ...... 8
Post-procesamiento, menú SETUP ..... 35
Procesamiento de Video, menú
SETUP ............................................. 34
PROGRAM, mando a distancia ............ 6
Programación de la reproducción ........ 26
Protector de pantalla, menú SETUP .... 31
Prueba de conexión, menú SETUP ..... 33
■
R
Red, conexión ...................................... 16
Red, menú SETUP ............................... 32
Reducción de ruido, menú SETUP ...... 35
REPEAT, mando a distancia ................. 7
Repetición Ins, menú en pantalla ......... 24
Reproducción Automática Disco,
menú SETUP ................................... 31
Reproducción, menú SETUP ............... 32
Requisitos de los archivos de audio ....... 3
RETURN, mando a distancia ................ 8
■
S
Salida 3D, menú SETUP ..................... 33
Salida de audio, menú SETUP ............ 35
SEARCH, mando a distancia ................ 7
Seguridad, menú SETUP ..................... 32
Seleccionar Salida de Video, menú
SETUP ............................................. 34
SETUP, mando a distancia .................... 6
SETUP, menú ...................................... 28
SHUFFLE, mando a distancia ............... 7
Sincronismo de labios, menú
SETUP ............................................. 34
Sistema de Información, menú
SETUP ............................................. 35
Sistema de TV, menú SETUP ............. 34
Sistema, menú SETUP ........................ 31
Software, actualización ........................ 38
STATUS, mando a distancia ................. 6
SUBTITLE, mando a distancia ............. 7
Subtítulo, menú en pantalla ................. 24
Subtítulo, menú SETUP ...................... 32
Subtítulos, menú SETUP ..................... 32
■
T
Título, menú en pantalla ...................... 24
TOP MENU, mando a distancia ............ 8
Transición, menú en pantalla ............... 24
TV, menú SETUP ................................ 33
■
U
USB, conexión ..................................... 16
■
V
Video secundario, menú en pantalla .... 24
Vídeo, conexión ................................... 13
Vídeo, formatos de salida .................... 37
■
5
Z
ZOOM, mando a distancia .................... 6
45 Es
Español
Cambiar Contraseña, menú SETUP .....32
Capítulo, menú en pantalla ..................24
Cargar configuración por defecto, menú
SETUP .............................................31
CLEAR, mando a distancia ...................6
Coaxial / Optica, menú SETUP ...........35
Code Page, menú en pantalla ...............24
Código de país, menú SETUP .............32
Color Space, menú SETUP ..................34
Conexión a Internet, menú SETUP ......32
Conexión BD-Live, menú SETUP .......33
Configuración de audio,
menú SETUP ...................................35
Configuración de conexión, menú
SETUP .............................................32
Configuración de pantalla, menú
SETUP .............................................33
Configuración General, menú
SETUP .............................................31
Configuración IP, menú SETUP ..........33
Configuración Proxy, menú SETUP ....33
Configuración Sencilla ........................18
Configuración Sencilla, menú
SETUP .............................................31
Contenido USB, reproducción .............18
Contenidos de YouTube,
reproducción ....................................21
Control de red, menú SETUP ..............31
Control HDMI, menú SETUP .............31
D
Información adicional
A/B, mando a distancia ..........................7
Actualización de software ....................38
Actualizar, menú SETUP .....................31
Ajuste de altavoz, menú SETUP ..........35
Ajuste de color, menú SETUP .............35
Almacenamiento Local, menú
SETUP .............................................31
ANGLE, mando a distancia ...................7
Ángulo, menú en pantalla ....................24
Asistente inicial ....................................18
Audio Secundario, menú en pantalla ...24
Audio, conexión ...................................14
Audio, formatos de salida ....................36
AUDIO, mando a distancia ....................7
Audio, menú en pantalla ......................24
Audio, menú SETUP ...........................32
Control Paterno, menú SETUP ............32
■
Information about software
This product uses the following software.
For information (copyright, etc) about each software, read the original sentences stated below.
■ About Linux, Busybox, SquashFS, LIRC, U-boot,
gdb, mtd-utils
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2, June 1991
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document,
but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and
change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your
freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for all its
users. This General Public License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation’s
software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it. (Some other Free
Software Foundation software is covered by the GNU Library General Public License
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General
Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute
copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source
code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in
new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you
these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you
must give the recipients all the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too,
receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know
their rights.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and (2) offer you this
license which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software.
Also, for each author’s protection and ours, we want to make certain that everyone
understands that there is no warranty for this free software. If the software is modified
by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to know that what they have is
not the original, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the
original authors’ reputations.
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to
avoid the danger that redistributors of a free program will individually obtain patent
licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it
clear that any patent must be licensed for everyone’s free use or not licensed at all.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND
MODIFICATION
0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains a notice placed
by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed under the terms of this General
Public License. The “Program”, below, refers to any such program or work, and a
“work based on the Program” means either the Program or any derivative work
under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another language.
(Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term “modification”.)
Each licensee is addressed as “you”.
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this
License; they are outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not restricted,
and the output from the Program is covered only if its contents constitute a work
based on the Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program’s source code as you
receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately
publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty;
keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any
warranty; and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License along
with the Program.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at
your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of it, thus
forming a work based on the Program, and copy and distribute such modifications
or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these
conditions:
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that you
changed the files and the date of any change.
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in whole or in part
contains or is derived from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed as a
whole at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this License.
i
c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when run, you
must cause it, when started running for such interactive use in the most
ordinary way, to print or display an announcement including an appropriate
copyright notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you
provide a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under these
conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this License. (Exception:
if the Program itself is interactive but does not normally print such an
announcement, your work based on the Program is not required to print an
announcement.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of
that work are not derived from the Program, and can be reasonably considered
independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Program,
the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions
for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless
of who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work
written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Program.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program with the
Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution
medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.
3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it, under Section 2)
in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above
provided that you also do one of the following:
a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code,
which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a
medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give any
third party, for a charge no more than your cost of physically performing source
distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of the corresponding source
code, to be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
customarily used for software interchange; or,
c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer to distribute
corresponding source code. (This alternative is allowed only for
noncommercial distribution and only if you received the program in object
code or executable form with such an offer, in accord with Subsection b
above.)
The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making
modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source code means all the source
code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the
scripts used to control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is
normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components
(compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs,
unless that component itself accompanies the executable.
If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering access to copy from a
designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same
place counts as distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program except as
expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify,
sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will automatically terminate your
rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights,
from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
parties remain in full compliance.
5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it. However,
nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Program or its
derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based
on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its
terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Program or works
based on it.
6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the Program), the
recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy,
distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms and conditions. You may
not impose any further restrictions on the recipients’ exercise of the rights granted
herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this
License.
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for
any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of
this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License
and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute
the Program at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free
redistribution of the Program by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly
through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be
to refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular
circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply and the section as a whole
is intended to apply in other circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other
property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole
purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous
contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance
on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or
she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
impose that choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence
of the rest of this License.
8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in certain countries either
by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places
the Program under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution
limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the
limitation as if written in the body of this License.
9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in
spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or
concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies a
version number of this License which applies to it and “any later version”, you have the
option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later
version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a
version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free
Software Foundation.
10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free programs whose
distribution conditions are different, write to the author to ask for permission. For
software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free
Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will be
guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free
software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
NO WARRANTY
11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE
PROGRAM “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED
TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER
PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS
PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING
ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA
BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR
THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH
ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the
public, the best way to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can
redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the
start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each
file should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where the full notice is
found.
<one line to give the program’s name and a brief idea of what it does.>
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the
terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with
this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St,
Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
when it starts in an interactive mode:
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of author Gnomovision comes
with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type ‘show w’. This is free
software, and you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions; type
‘show c’ for details.
The hypothetical commands ‘show w’ and ‘show c’ should show the appropriate parts
of the General Public License. Of course, the commands you use may be called
something other than ‘show w’ and ‘show c’; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu
items--whatever suits your program.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if
any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample;
alter the names:
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program
‘Gnomovision’ (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989
Ty Coon, President of Vice
This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more
useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you
want to do, use the GNU Library General
Public License instead of this License..
■ About glibc, libmtp, libusb, libusb-compat, DirectFB,
SaWMan
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2.1, February 1999
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document,
but changing it is not allowed.
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also counts as the successor of
the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence the version number 2.1.]
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and
change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee
your freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for
all its users.
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some specially designated
software packages--typically libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other
authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we suggest you first think carefully
about whether this license or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy
to use in any particular case, based on the explanations below.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use, not price. Our
General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to
distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish); that you
receive source code or can get it if you want it; that you can change the software and
use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed that you can do these
things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you
these rights or to ask you to surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to
certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must
give the recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too,
receive or can get the source code. If you link other code with the library, you must
provide complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them with the
library after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And you must show
them these terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the library, and (2) we
offer you this license, which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or
modify the library.
To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear that there is no warranty for
the free library. Also, if the library is modified by someone else and passed on, the
recipients should know that what they have is not the original version, so that the
original author’s reputation will not be affected by problems that might be introduced
by others.
Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of any free program.
We wish to make sure that a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free
program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist
that any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with the
full freedom of use specified in this license.
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the ordinary GNU General
Public License. This license, the GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to
certain designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary General Public
License. We use this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those
libraries into non-free programs.
When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using a shared library, the
combination of the two is legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the original
library. The ordinary General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the
entire combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General Public License
permits more lax criteria for linking other code with the library.
We call this license the “Lesser” General Public License because it does Less to protect
the user’s freedom than the ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free
software developers Less of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These
disadvantages are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many
libraries. However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain special
circumstances.
For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to encourage the widest
possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve this,
non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. A more frequent case is that a
free library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is
little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, so we use the Lesser
General Public License.
ii
In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non-free programs enables a
greater number of people to use a large body of free software. For example, permission
to use the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many more people to use the
whole GNU operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system.
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the users’ freedom, it
does ensure that the user of a program that is linked with the Library has the freedom
and the wherewithal to run that program using a modified version of the Library.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
Pay close attention to the difference between a “work based on the library” and a “work
that uses the library”. The former contains code derived from the library, whereas the
latter must be combined with the library in order to run.
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND
MODIFICATION
0. This License Agreement applies to any software library or other program which
contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or other authorized party saying it
may be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Public License (also
called “this License”). Each licensee is addressed as “you”.
A “library” means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be
conveniently linked with application programs (which use some of those functions and
data) to form executables.
The “Library”, below, refers to any such software library or work which has been
distributed under these terms. A “work based on the Library” means either the Library
or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the
Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated
straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without
limitation in the term “modification”.)
“Source code” for a work means the preferred form of the work for making
modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means all the source code for
all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts
used to control compilation and installation of the library.
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this
License; they are outside its scope. The act of running a program using the Library is
not restricted, and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute
a work based on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing
it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does and what the program that
uses the Library does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library’s complete source
code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer
of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence
of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the Library.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your
option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion of it, thus
forming a work based on the Library, and copy and distribute such modifications or
work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these
conditions:
a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices stating that you
changed the files and the date of any change.
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third
parties under the terms of this License.
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be
supplied by an application program that uses the facility, other than as an
argument passed when the facility is invoked, then you must make a good faith
effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such function
or table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its purpose
remains meaningful.
(For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is
entirely well-defined independent of the application. Therefore, Subsection 2d
requires that any application-supplied function or table used by this function must
be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square root function must still
compute square roots.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of
that work are not derived from the Library, and can be reasonably considered
independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not
apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Library, the
distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for
other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of
who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work
written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the
distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Library.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library with the Library
(or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium
does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.
3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License
instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all
the notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the ordinary GNU General
Public License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a newer version than
version 2 of the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can
specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change in these
notices.
iii
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary
GNU General Public License applies to all subsequent copies and derivative works
made from that copy.
This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the Library into a
program that is not a library.
4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or derivative of it, under
Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
above provided that you accompany it with the complete corresponding machinereadable source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
above on a medium customarily used for software interchange.
If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated
place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place
satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even though third parties are not
compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the Library, but is designed
to work with the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is called a “work that
uses the Library”. Such a work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library,
and therefore falls outside the scope of this License.
However, linking a “work that uses the Library” with the Library creates an executable
that is a derivative of the Library (because it contains portions of the Library), rather
than a “work that uses the library”. The executable is therefore covered by this License.
Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables.
When a “work that uses the Library” uses material from a header file that is part of the
Library, the object code for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even
though the source code is not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the work
can be linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold for
this to be true is not precisely defined by law.
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and
accessors, and small macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in length), then
the use of the object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative
work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the Library will still
fall under Section 6.)
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may distribute the object code
for the work under the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that work also
fall under Section 6, whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also combine or link a ‘work that
uses the Library” with the Library to produce a work containing portions of the
Library, and distribute that work under terms of your choice, provided that the
terms permit modification of the work for the customer’s own use and reverse
engineering for debugging such modifications.
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the Library is used in
it and that the Library and its use are covered by this License. You must supply a copy
of this License. If the work during execution displays copyright notices, you must
include the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference
directing the user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one of these things:
a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable
source code for the Library including whatever changes were used in the work
(which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an
executable linked with the Library, with the complete machine-readable “work
that uses the Library”, as object code and/or source code, so that the user can
modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified executable containing
the modified Library. (It is understood that the user who changes the contents
of definitions files in the Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the
application to use the modified definitions.)
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the Library. A
suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the library already
present on the user’s computer system, rather than copying library functions
into the executable, and (2) will operate properly with a modified version of the
library, if the user installs one, as long as the modified version is interfacecompatible with the version that the work was made with.
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give
the same user the materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no
more than the cost of performing this distribution.
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a designated
place, offer equivalent access to copy the above specified materials from the
same place.
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you
have already sent this user a copy.
For an executable, the required form of the “work that uses the Library” must include
any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However,
as a special exception, the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is
normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components
(compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs,
unless that component itself accompanies the executable.
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license restrictions of other
proprietary libraries that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a
contradiction means you cannot use both them and the Library together in an executable
that you distribute.
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on the Library side-by-side in
a single library together with other library facilities not covered by this License,
and distribute such a combined library, provided that the separate distribution of the
work based on the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted,
and provided that you do these two things:
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the
Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must be distributed
under the terms of the Sections above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a
work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the accompanying
uncombined form of the same work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library except as
expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify,
sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is void, and will automatically
terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received
copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses
terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
9. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it. However,
nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Library or its
derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Library (or any work based on
the Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its terms
and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Library or works based
on it.
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the Library), the
recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy,
distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to these terms and conditions.
You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients’ exercise of the rights
granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties
with this License.
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for
any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of
this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you
cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License
and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute
the Library at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free
redistribution of the Library by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly
through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be
to refrain entirely from distribution of the Library.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular
circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply, and the section as a whole
is intended to apply in other circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other
property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole
purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is
implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous
contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance
on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or
she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
impose that choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence
of the rest of this License.
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in certain countries either
by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places
the Library under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution
limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or
among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the
limitation as if written in the body of this License.
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar
in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or
concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library specifies a
version number of this License which applies to it and “any later version”, you have the
option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later
version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
license version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free
Software Foundation.
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free programs whose
distribution conditions are incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for
permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation,
write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.
Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all
derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software
generally.
NO WARRANTY
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE
LIBRARY “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED
TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER
PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS
PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING
ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA
BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR
THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH
ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the
public, we recommend making it free software that everyone can redistribute and
change. You can do so by permitting redistribution under these terms (or, alternatively,
under the terms of the ordinary General Public License).
To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the library. It is safest to attach
them to the start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of
warranty; and each file should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where
the full notice is found.
<one line to give the library’s name and a brief idea of what it does.> Copyright (C)
<year> <name of author>
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms
of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by the Free Software
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser General Public
License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License along
with this library; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple
Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if
any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample;
alter the names:
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the library ‘Frob’ (a
library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker.
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990 Ty Coon, President of Vice
That’s all there is to it!
■ About Fusion
DirectFB Fusion kernel module: introduction and API
by Niels Roest
Copyright (C) 2009 Niels Roest
This documentation is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the
terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any
later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with this
program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
For more details see the file COPYING in the source distribution of Linux.
■ About openssl
Copyright (C) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this
list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display
the following acknowledgment:
“This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the
OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)”
4. The names “OpenSSL Toolkit” and “OpenSSL Project” must not be used to
endorse or promote products derived from this software without prior written
permission. For written permission, please contact openssl-core@openssl.org.
5. Products derived from this software may not be called “OpenSSL” nor may
“OpenSSL” appear in their names without prior written permission of the OpenSSL
Project.
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
acknowledgment:
‘This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the
OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)”
iv
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF
THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Original SSLeay License
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved.
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com).
The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL.
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following
conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply to all code found in this
distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The
SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright
terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Copyright remains Eric Young’s, and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not
to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given
attribution as the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the form of a
textual message at program startup or in documentation (online or textual) provided
with the package.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display
the following acknowledgement:
“This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com)” The word ‘cryptographic’ can be left out if the rouines from
the library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the apps
directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement:
“This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)”
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of
this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under
another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.]
■ About zlib
Copyright notice:
(C) 1995-2004 Jean-loup Gailly and Mark Adler
This software is provided ‘as-is’, without any express or implied warranty. In no event
will the authors be held liable for any damages arising from the use of this software.
Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose, including
commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the
following restrictions:
1. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not claim that you
wrote the original software. If you use this software in a product, an
acknowledgment in the product documentation would be appreciated but is not
required.
2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be
misrepresented as being the original software.
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any source distribution.
Jean-loup Gailly
Mark Adler
jloup@gzip.org
madler@alumni.caltech.edu
If you use the zlib library in a product, we would appreciate *not* receiving lengthy
legal documents to sign. The sources are provided for free but without warranty of any
kind. The library has been entirely written by Jean-loup Gailly and Mark Adler; it does
not include third-party code.
If you redistribute modified sources, we would appreciate that you include in the file
ChangeLog history information documenting your changes. Please read the FAQ for
more information on the distribution of modified source versions.
v
■ About FreeType
The FreeType Project LICENSE
2006-Jan-27
Copyright 1996-2002, 2006 by
David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg
Introduction
The FreeType Project is distributed in several archive packages; some of them may
contain, in addition to the FreeType font engine, various tools and contributions which
rely on, or relate to, the FreeType Project.
This license applies to all files found in such packages, and which do not fall under their
own explicit license. The license affects thus the FreeType font engine, the test
programs, documentation and makefiles, at the very least.
This license was inspired by the BSD, Artistic, and IJG (Independent JPEG Group)
licenses, which all encourage inclusion and use of free software in commercial and
freeware products alike. As a consequence, its main points are that:
o We don’t promise that this software works. However, we will be interested in any
kind of bug reports. (‘as is’ distribution)
o You can use this software for whatever you want, in parts or full form, without
having to pay us. (‘royalty-free’ usage)
o You may not pretend that you wrote this software. If you use it, or only parts of it, in
a program, you must acknowledge somewhere in your documentation that you have
used the FreeType code. (‘credits’)
We specifically permit and encourage the inclusion of this software, with or without
modifications, in commercial products. We disclaim all warranties covering The
FreeType Project and assume no liability related to The FreeType Project.
Finally, many people asked us for a preferred form for a credit/disclaimer to use in
compliance with this license. We thus encourage you to use the following text:
Portions of this software are copyright (C) <year> The FreeType Project
(www.freetype.org). All rights reserved.
Please replace <year> with the value from the FreeType version you actually use.
Legal Terms
0. Definitions
Throughout this license, the terms ‘package’, ‘FreeType Project’, and ‘FreeType
archive’ refer to the set of files originally distributed by the authors (David Turner,
Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg) as the ‘FreeType Project’, be they named as
alpha, beta or final release.
‘You’ refers to the licensee, or person using the project, where ‘using’ is a generic term
including compiling the project’s source code as well as linking it to form a ‘program’
or ‘executable’. This program is referred to as ‘a program using the FreeType engine’.
This license applies to all files distributed in the original FreeType Project, including
all source code, binaries and documentation, unless otherwise stated in the file in its
original, unmodified form as distributed in the original archive. If you are unsure
whether or not a particular file is covered by this license, you must contact us to verify
this.
The FreeType Project is copyright (C) 1996-2000 by David Turner, Robert Wilhelm,
and Werner Lemberg. All rights reserved except as specified below.
1. No Warranty
THE FREETYPE PROJECT IS PROVIDED ‘AS IS’ WITHOUT WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
TO, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT WILL ANY OF THE AUTHORS OR
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE
USE OR THE INABILITY TO USE, OF THE FREETYPE PROJECT.
2. Redistribution
This license grants a worldwide, royalty-free, perpetual and irrevocable right and
license to use, execute, perform, compile, display, copy, create derivative works of,
distribute and sublicense the FreeType Project (in both source and object code forms)
and derivative works thereof for any purpose; and to authorize others to exercise some
or all of the rights granted herein, subject to the following conditions:
o Redistribution of source code must retain this license file (‘FTL.TXT’) unaltered;
any additions, deletions or changes to the original files must be clearly indicated in
accompanying documentation. The copyright notices of the unaltered, original files
must be preserved in all copies of source files.
o Redistribution in binary form must provide a disclaimer that states that the software
is based in part of the work of the FreeType Team, in the distribution documentation.
We also encourage you to put an URL to the FreeType web page in your
documentation, though this isn’t mandatory.
These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the FreeType Project,
not just the unmodified files. If you use our work, you must acknowledge us. However,
no fee need be paid to us.
3. Advertising
Neither the FreeType authors and contributors nor you shall use the name of the other
for commercial, advertising, or promotional purposes without specific prior written
permission.
We suggest, but do not require, that you use one or more of the following phrases to
refer to this software in your documentation or advertising materials: ‘FreeType
Project’, ‘FreeType Engine’, ‘FreeType library’, or ‘FreeType Distribution’.
As you have not signed this license, you are not required to accept it. However, as the
FreeType Project is copyrighted material, only this license, or another one contracted
with the authors, grants you the right to use, distribute, and modify it. Therefore, by
using, distributing, or modifying the FreeType Project, you indicate that you understand
and accept all the terms of this license.
4. Contacts
There are two mailing lists related to FreeType:
o freetype@nongnu.org
Discusses general use and applications of FreeType, as well as future and wanted
additions to the library and distribution. If you are looking for support, start in this list if
you haven’t found anything to help you in the documentation.
o freetype-devel@nongnu.org
Discusses bugs, as well as engine internals, design issues, specific licenses, porting, etc.
Our home page can be found at
http://www.freetype.org
■ About Expat
Copyright (C) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Center Ltd
and Clark Cooper
Copyright (C) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Expat maintainers.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this
software and associated documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the Software
without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons
to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or
substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS
OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR
OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
■ About cURL, libcurl
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright (C) 1996 - 2009, Daniel Stenberg, <daniel@haxx.se>.
All rights reserved.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose with or
without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this
permission notice appear in all copies.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION
OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
■ About Independent JPEG Group’s software, libjpeg
In plain English:
1. We don’t promise that this software works. (But if you find any bugs, please let us
know!)
2. You can use this software for whatever you want. You don’t have to pay us.
3. You may not pretend that you wrote this software. If you use it in a program, you
must acknowledge somewhere in your documentation that you’ve used the IJG code.
In legalese:
The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation, either express or implied, with
respect to this software, its quality, accuracy, merchantability, or fitness for a particular
purpose. This software is provided “AS IS”, and you, its user, assume the entire risk as
to its quality and accuracy.
This software is copyright (C) 1991-2009, Thomas G. Lane, Guido Vollbeding.
All Rights Reserved except as specified below.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software (or
portions thereof) for any purpose, without fee, subject to these conditions:
(1) If any part of the source code for this software is distributed, then this README file
must be included, with this copyright and no-warranty notice unaltered; and any
additions, deletions, or changes to the original files must be clearly indicated in
accompanying documentation.
(2) If only executable code is distributed, then the accompanying documentation must
state that “this software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group”.
(3) Permission for use of this software is granted only if the user accepts full
responsibility for any undesirable consequences; the authors accept NO LIABILITY for
damages of any kind.
These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the IJG code, not just
to the unmodified library. If you use our work, you ought to acknowledge us.
Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG author’s name or company name in
advertising or publicity relating to this software or products derived from it. This
software may be referred to only as “the Independent JPEG Group’s software”.
We specifically permit and encourage the use of this software as the basis of
commercial products, provided that all warranty or liability claims are assumed by the
product vendor.
ansi2knr.c is included in this distribution by permission of L. Peter Deutsch, sole
proprietor of its copyright holder, Aladdin Enterprises of Menlo Park, CA. ansi2knr.c is
NOT covered by the above copyright and conditions, but instead by the usual
distribution terms of the Free Software Foundation; principally, that you must include
source code if you redistribute it. (See the file ansi2knr.c for full details.) However,
since ansi2knr.c is not needed as part of any program generated from the IJG code, this
does not limit you more than the foregoing paragraphs do.
The Unix configuration script “configure” was produced with GNU Autoconf. It is
copyright by the Free Software Foundation but is freely distributable. The same holds
for its supporting scripts (config.guess, config.sub, ltmain.sh). Another support script,
install-sh, is copyright by X Consortium but is also freely distributable.
The IJG distribution formerly included code to read and write GIF files. To avoid
entanglement with the Unisys LZW patent, GIF reading support has been removed
altogether, and the GIF writer has been simplified to produce “uncompressed GIFs”.
This technique does not use the LZW algorithm; the resulting GIF files are larger than
usual, but are readable by all standard GIF decoders.
We are required to state that
“The Graphics Interchange Format(c) is the Copyright property of
CompuServe Incorporated. GIF(sm) is a Service Mark property of
CompuServe Incorporated.”
■ About International Components for Unicode
ICU License - ICU 1.8.1 and later
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright (C) 1995-2003 International Business Machines Corporation and others
All rights reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this
software and associated documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the Software
without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom
the Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above copyright notice(s) and this
permission notice appear in all copies of the Software and that both the above copyright
notice(s) and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR HOLDERS INCLUDED IN THIS
NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER
RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE
OF THIS SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software
without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
All trademarks and registered trademarks mentioned herein are the property of their
respective owners.
■ About libpng
This copy of the libpng notices is provided for your convenience. In case of any
discrepancy between this copy and the notices in the file png.h that is included in the
libpng distribution, the latter shall prevail.
COPYRIGHT NOTICE, DISCLAIMER, and LICENSE:
If you modify libpng you may insert additional notices immediately following this
sentence. This code is released under the libpng license.
libpng versions 1.2.6, August 15, 2004, through 1.2.47, February 18, 2012, are
Copyright (C) 2004, 2006-2009 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and are distributed according
to the same disclaimer and license as libpng-1.2.5 with the following individual added
to the list of Contributing Authors
Cosmin Truta
libpng versions 1.0.7, July 1, 2000, through 1.2.5 - October 3, 2002, are Copyright
(C) 2000-2002 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and are distributed according to the same
disclaimer and license as libpng-1.0.6 with the following individuals added to the
list of Contributing Authors
Simon-Pierre Cadieux
Eric S. Raymond
Gilles Vollant
and with the following additions to the disclaimer:
There is no warranty against interference with your enjoyment of the library or
against infringement. There is no warranty that our efforts or the library will fulfill
any of your particular purposes or needs. This library is provided with all faults,
and the entire risk of satisfactory quality, performance, accuracy, and effort is with
the user.
libpng versions 0.97, January 1998, through 1.0.6, March 20, 2000, are Copyright (C)
1998, 1999 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and are distributed according to the same
disclaimer and license as libpng-0.96, with the following individuals added to the list of
Contributing Authors:
Tom Lane
Glenn Randers-Pehrson
Willem van Schaik
libpng versions 0.89, June 1996, through 0.96, May 1997, are Copyright (C) 1996, 1997
Andreas Dilger Distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng-0.88,
with the following individuals added to the list of Contributing Authors:
John Bowler
Kevin Bracey
Sam Bushell
Magnus Holmgren
vi
Greg Roelofs
Tom Tanner
libpng versions 0.5, May 1995, through 0.88, January 1996, are Copyright (C) 1995,
1996 Guy Eric Schalnat, Group 42, Inc.
For the purposes of this copyright and license, “Contributing Authors” is defined as the
following set of individuals:
Andreas Dilger
Dave Martindale
Guy Eric Schalnat
Paul Schmidt
Tim Wegner
The PNG Reference Library is supplied “AS IS”. The Contributing Authors and Group
42, Inc. disclaim all warranties, expressed or implied, including, without limitation, the
warranties of merchantability and of fitness for any purpose. The Contributing Authors
and Group 42, Inc. assume no liability for direct, indirect, incidental, special,
exemplary, or consequential damages, which may result from the use of the PNG
Reference Library, even if advised of the possibility of such damage.
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this source code, or
portions hereof, for any purpose, without fee, subject to the following restrictions:
1. The origin of this source code must not be misrepresented.
2. Altered versions must be plainly marked as such and must not be misrepresented
as being the original source.
3. This Copyright notice may not be removed or altered from any source or altered
source distribution.
The Contributing Authors and Group 42, Inc. specifically permit, without fee, and
encourage the use of this source code as a component to supporting the PNG file format
in commercial products. If you use this source code in a product, acknowledgment is
not required but would be appreciated.
A “png_get_copyright” function is available, for convenient use in “about” boxes and
the like:
printf(“%s”,png_get_copyright(NULL));
Also, the PNG logo (in PNG format, of course) is supplied in the files “pngbar.png” and
“pngbar.jpg (88x31) and “pngnow.png” (98x31).
Libpng is OSI Certified Open Source Software. OSI Certified Open Source is a
certification mark of the Open Source Initiative.
Glenn Randers-Pehrson
glennrp at users.sourceforge.net
February 18, 2012
■ About gSOAP
gSOAP Public License
Version 1.3b
The gSOAP public license is derived from the Mozilla Public License (MPL1.1). The
sections that were deleted
from the original MPL1.1 text are 1.0.1, 2.1.(c),(d), 2.2.(c),(d), 8.2.(b), 10, and 11.
Section 3.8 was added. The
modified sections are 2.1.(b), 2.2.(b), 3.2 (simplified), 3.5 (deleted the last sentence),
and 3.6 (simplified).
This license applies to the gSOAP software package, with the exception of the wsdl2h
source code located in
gsoap/wsdl, all code generated by wsdl2h, the UDDI source code gsoap/uddi2, and the
Web server sample
source code samples/webserver. To use all of the software commercially, a commercial
license has to be obtained
from www.genivia.com.
1 DEFINITIONS.
1.0.1.
1.1. “Contributor” means each entity that creates or contributes to the creation of
Modifications.
1.2. “Contributor Version” means the combination of the Original Code, prior
Modifications used by a Contributor, and the Modifications made by that particular
Contributor.
1.3. “Covered Code” means the Original Code, or Modifications or the combination of
the Original Code, and Modifications, in each case including portions thereof.
1.4. “Electronic Distribution Mechanism” means a mechanism generally accepted in
the software development community for the electronic transfer of data.
1.5. “Executable” means Covered Code in any form other than Source Code.
1.6. “Initial Developer” means the individual or entity identified as the Initial
Developer in the Source Code notice required by Exhibit A.
1.7. “Larger Work” means a work which combines Covered Code or portions thereof
with code not governed by the terms of this License.
1.8. “License” means this document.
1.8.1. “Licensable” means having the right to grant, to the maximum extent possible,
whether at the time of the initial grant or subsequently acquired, any and all of the rights
conveyed herein.
1.9. “Modifications” means any addition to or deletion from the substance or structure
of either the Original Code or any previous Modifications. When Covered Code is
released as a series of files, a Modification is: A.
Any addition to or deletion from the contents of a file containing Original Code or
previous Modifications. B.
Any new file that contains any part of the Original Code, or previous Modifications.
1.10. “Original Code” means Source Code of computer software code which is
described in the Source Code notice required by Exhibit A as Original Code, and which,
at the time of its release under this License is not already Covered Code governed by
this License.
vii
1.10.1. “Patent Claims” means any patent claim(s), now owned or hereafter acquired,
including without limitation, method, process, and apparatus claims, in any patent
Licensable by grantor.
http://www.cs.fsu.edu/~engelen/license.html
1.11. “Source Code” means the preferred form of the Covered Code for making
modifications to it, including all modules it contains, plus any associated interface
definition files, scripts used to control compilation and installation of an Executable, or
source code differential comparisons against either the Original Code or another well
known, available Covered Code of the Contributor’s choice. The Source Code can be in
a compressed or archival form, provided the appropriate decompression or de-archiving
software is widely available for no charge.
1.12. “You” (or “Your”) means an individual or a legal entity exercising rights under,
and complying with all of the terms of, this License or a future version of this License
issued under Section 6.1. For legal entities, “You” includes any entity which controls, is
controlled by, or is under common control with You. For purposes of this definition,
“control” means (a) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the direction or management
of such entity, whether by contract or otherwise, or (b) ownership of more than fifty
percent (50%) of the outstanding shares or beneficial ownership of such entity.
2 SOURCE CODE LICENSE.
2.1. The Initial Developer Grant. The Initial Developer hereby grants You a worldwide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license, subject to third party intellectual property
claims:
(a)
under intellectual property rights (other than patent or trademark) Licensable by Initial
Developer to use, reproduce, modify, display, perform, sublicense and distribute the
Original Code (or portions thereof) with or without Modifications, and/or as part of a
Larger Work; and
(b)
under patents now or hereafter owned or controlled by Initial Developer, to make, have
made, use and sell (“offer to sell and import”) the Original Code, Modifications, or
portions thereof, but solely to the extent that any such patent is reasonably necessary to
enable You to utilize, alone or in combination with other software, the Original Code,
Modifications, or any combination or portions thereof.
(c)
(d)
2.2. Contributor Grant.
Subject to third party intellectual property claims, each Contributor hereby grants You a
world-wide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license
(a)
under intellectual property rights (other than patent or trademark) Licensable by
Contributor, to use, reproduce, modify, display, perform, sublicense and distribute the
Modifications created by such Contributor (or portions thereof) either on an unmodified
basis, with other Modifications, as Covered Code and/or as part of a Larger Work; and
(b)
under patents now or hereafter owned or controlled by Contributor, to make, have
made, use and sell (“offer to sell and import”) the Contributor Version (or portions
thereof), but solely to the extent that any such patent is reasonably necessary to enable
You to utilize, alone or in combination with other software, the Contributor Version (or
portions thereof).
(c)
(d)
3 DISTRIBUTION OBLIGATIONS.
3.1. Application of License.
The Modifications which You create or to which You contribute are governed by the
terms of this License, including without limitation Section 2.2. The Source Code
version of Covered Code may be distributed only under the terms of this License or a
future version of this License released under Section 6.1, and You must include a copy
of this License with every copy of the Source Code You distribute. You may not offer
or impose any terms on any Source Code version that alters or restricts the applicable
version of this License or the recipients’ rights hereunder. However, You may include
an additional document offering the additional rights described in Section 3.5.
3.2. Availability of Source Code.
Any Modification created by You will be provided to the Initial Developer in Source
Code form and are subject to the terms of the License.
3.3. Description of Modifications.
You must cause all Covered Code to which You contribute to contain a file
documenting the changes You made to create that Covered Code and the date of any
change. You must include a prominent statement that the Modification is derived,
directly or indirectly, from Original Code provided by the Initial Developer and
including the name of the Initial Developer in (a) the Source Code, and (b) in any notice
in an Executable version or related documentation in which You describe the origin or
ownership of the Covered Code.
3.4. Intellectual Property Matters.
(a) Third Party Claims.
If Contributor has knowledge that a license under a third party’s intellectual property
rights is required to exercise the rights granted by such Contributor under Sections 2.1
or 2.2, Contributor must include a text file with the Source Code distribution titled
“LEGAL” which describes the claim and the party making the claim in sufficient detail
that a recipient will know whom to contact. If Contributor obtains such knowledge after
the Modification is made available as described in Section 3.2, Contributor shall
promptly modify the LEGAL file in all copies Contributor makes available thereafter
and shall take other steps (such as notifying appropriate mailing lists or newsgroups)
reasonably calculated to inform those who received the Covered Code that new
knowledge has been obtained.
(b) Contributor APIs.
If Contributor’s Modifications include an application programming interface and
Contributor has knowledge of patent licenses which are reasonably necessary to
implement that API, Contributor must also include this information in the LEGAL file.
(c) Representations.
Contributor represents that, except as disclosed pursuant to Section 3.4(a) above,
Contributor believes that Contributor’s Modifications are Contributor’s original
creation(s) and/or Contributor has sufficient rights to grant the rights conveyed by this
License.
3.5. Required Notices.
You must duplicate the notice in Exhibit A in each file of the Source Code. If it is not
possible to put such notice in a particular Source Code file due to its structure, then You
must include such notice in a location (such as a relevant directory) where a user would
be likely to look for such a notice. If You created one or more Modification(s) You may
add your name as a Contributor to the notice described in Exhibit A. You must also
duplicate this License in any documentation for the Source Code where You describe
recipients’ rights or ownership rights relating to Covered Code. You may choose to
offer, and to charge a fee for, warranty, support, indemnity or liability obligations to
one or more recipients of Covered Code. However, You may do so only on Your own
behalf, and not on behalf of the Initial Developer or any Contributor.
3.6. Distribution of Executable Versions.
You may distribute Covered Code in Executable form only if the requirements of
Section 3.1-3.5 have been met for that Covered Code. You may distribute the
Executable version of Covered Code or ownership rights under a license of Your
choice, which may contain terms different from this License, provided that You are in
compliance with the terms of this License and that the license for the Executable
version does not attempt to limit or alter the recipient’s rights in the Source Code
version from the rights set forth in this License. If You distribute the Executable version
under a different license You must make it absolutely clear that any terms which differ
from this License are offered by You alone, not by the Initial Developer or any
Contributor. If you distribute executable versions containing Covered Code as part of a
product, you must reproduce the notice in Exhibit B in the documentation and/or other
materials provided with the product.
3.7. Larger Works.
You may create a Larger Work by combining Covered Code with other code not
governed by the terms of this License and distribute the Larger Work as a single
product. In such a case, You must make sure the requirements of this License are
fulfilled for the Covered Code.
3.8. Restrictions.
You may not remove any product identification, copyright, proprietary notices or labels
from gSOAP.
4 INABILITY TO COMPLY DUE TO STATUTE OR REGULATION.
If it is impossible for You to comply with any of the terms of this License with respect
to some or all of the Covered Code due to statute, judicial order, or regulation then You
must: (a) comply with the terms of this License to the maximum extent possible; and
(b) describe the limitations and the code they affect. Such description must be included
in the LEGAL file described in Section 3.4 and must be included with all distributions
of the Source Code. Except to the extent prohibited by statute or regulation, such
description must be sufficiently detailed for a recipient of ordinary skill to be able to
understand it.
5 APPLICATION OF THIS LICENSE.
This License applies to code to which the Initial Developer has attached the notice in
Exhibit A and to related Covered Code.
6 VERSIONS OF THE LICENSE.
6.1. New Versions.
Grantor may publish revised and/or new versions of the License from time to time.
Each version will be given a distinguishing version number.
6.2. Effect of New Versions.
Once Covered Code has been published under a particular version of the License, You
may always continue to use it under the terms of that version. You may also choose to
use such Covered Code under the terms of any subsequent version of the License.
6.3. Derivative Works.
If You create or use a modified version of this License (which you may only do in order
to apply it to code which is not already Covered Code governed by this License), You
must (a) rename Your license so that the phrase “gSOAP” or any confusingly similar
phrase do not appear in your license (except to note that your license differs from this
License) and (b) otherwise make it clear that Your version of the license contains terms
which differ from the gSOAP Public License. (Filling in the name of the Initial
Developer, Original Code or Contributor in the notice described in Exhibit A shall not
of themselves be deemed to be modifications of this License.)
7 DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY.
COVERED CODE IS PROVIDED UNDER THIS LICENSE ON AN “AS IS” BASIS,
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR
STATUTORY, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, OF FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE, NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY INTELLECTUAL
PROPERTY RIGHTS, AND ANY WARRANTY THAT MAY ARISE BY REASON
OF TRADE USAGE, CUSTOM, OR COURSE OF DEALING. WITHOUT
LIMITING THE FOREGOING, YOU ACKNOWLEDGE THAT THE SOFTWARE
IS PROVIDED “AS IS” AND THAT THE AUTHORS DO NOT WARRANT THE
SOFTWARE WILL RUN UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR FREE. LIMITED
LIABILITY THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO RESULTS AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
SOFTWARE IS ASSUMED BY YOU. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES WILL THE
AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND OR NATURE
WHATSOEVER, WHETHER BASED ON CONTRACT, WARRANTY, TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), STRICT LIABILITY OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
OUT OF OR IN ANY WAY RELATED TO THE SOFTWARE, EVEN IF THE
AUTHORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED ON THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE
OR IF SUCH DAMAGE COULD HAVE BEEN REASONABLY FORESEEN, AND
NOTWITHSTANDING ANY FAILURE OF ESSENTIAL PURPOSE OF ANY
EXCLUSIVE REMEDY PROVIDED. SUCH LIMITATION ON DAMAGES
INCLUDES, BUT IS NOT LIMITED TO, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL,
LOST PROFITS, LOSS OF DATA OR SOFTWARE, WORK STOPPAGE,
COMPUTER FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION OR IMPAIRMENT OF OTHER
GOODS. IN NO EVENT WILL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR THE COSTS OF
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES. YOU
ACKNOWLEDGE THAT THIS SOFTWARE IS NOT DESIGNED FOR USE IN ONLINE EQUIPMENT IN HAZARDOUS ENVIRONMENTS SUCH AS OPERATION
OF NUCLEAR FACILITIES, AIRCRAFT NAVIGATION OR CONTROL, OR LIFECRITICAL APPLICATIONS. THE AUTHORS EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM ANY
LIABILITY RESULTING FROM USE OF THE SOFTWARE IN ANY SUCH ONLINE EQUIPMENT IN HAZARDOUS ENVIRONMENTS AND ACCEPTS NO
LIABILITY IN RESPECT OF ANY ACTIONS OR CLAIMS BASED ON THE USE
OF THE SOFTWARE IN ANY SUCH ON-LINE EQUIPMENT IN HAZARDOUS
ENVIRONMENTS BY YOU. FOR PURPOSES OF THIS PARAGRAPH, THE
TERM “LIFE- CRITICAL APPLICATION” MEANS AN APPLICATION IN
WHICH THE FUNCTIONING OR MALFUNCTIONING OF THE SOFTWARE
MAY RESULT DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY IN PHYSICAL INJURY OR LOSS
OF HUMAN LIFE. THIS DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY CONSTITUTES AN
ESSENTIAL PART OF THIS LICENSE. NO USE OF ANY COVERED CODE IS
AUTHORIZED HEREUNDER EXCEPT UNDER THIS DISCLAIMER.
8 TERMINATION.
8.1.
This License and the rights granted hereunder will terminate automatically if You fail to
comply with terms herein and fail to cure such breach within 30 days of becoming
aware of the breach. All sublicenses to the Covered Code which are properly granted
shall survive any termination of this License. Provisions which, by their nature, must
remain in effect beyond the termination of this License shall survive.
8.2.
8.3.
If You assert a patent infringement claim against Participant alleging that such
Participant’s Contributor Version directly or indirectly infringes any patent where such
claim is resolved (such as by license or settlement) prior to the initiation of patent
infringement litigation, then the reasonable value of the licenses granted by such
Participant under Sections 2.1 or 2.2 shall be taken into account in determining the
amount or value of any payment or license.
8.4.
In the event of termination under Sections 8.1 or 8.2 above, all end user license
agreements (excluding distributors and resellers) which have been validly granted by
You or any distributor hereunder prior to termination shall survive termination.
9 LIMITATION OF LIABILITY.
UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES AND UNDER NO LEGAL THEORY, WHETHER
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), CONTRACT, OR OTHERWISE, SHALL
YOU, THE INITIAL DEVELOPER, ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR, OR ANY
DISTRIBUTOR OF COVERED CODE, OR ANY SUPPLIER OF ANY OF SUCH
PARTIES, BE LIABLE TO ANY PERSON FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL,
INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY CHARACTER
INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL,
WORK STOPPAGE, COMPUTER FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION, OR ANY AND
ALL OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES, EVEN IF SUCH PARTY
SHALL HAVE BEEN INFORMED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
THIS LIMITATION OF LIABILITY SHALL NOT APPLY TO LIABILITY FOR
DEATH OR PERSONAL INJURY RESULTING FROM SUCH PARTY’S
NEGLIGENCE TO THE EXTENT APPLICABLE LAW PROHIBITS SUCH
LIMITATION. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR
LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THIS
EXCLUSION AND LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU.
10 U.S. GOVERNMENT END USERS.
11 MISCELLANEOUS.
12 RESPONSIBILITY FOR CLAIMS.
As between Initial Developer and the Contributors, each party is responsible for claims
and damages arising, directly or indirectly, out of its utilization of rights under this
License and You agree to work with Initial Developer and Contributors to distribute
such responsibility on an equitable basis. Nothing herein is intended or shall be deemed
to constitute any admission of liability.
EXHIBIT A.
“The contents of this file are subject to the gSOAP Public License Version 1.3 (the
“License”); you may not use this
file except in compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at
http://www.cs.fsu.edu/ engelen/soaplicense.html
Software distributed under the License is distributed on an “AS IS” basis, WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License for the
specific language governing rights and limitations under the License.
The Original Code of the gSOAP Software is: stdsoap.h, stdsoap2.h, stdsoap.c,
stdsoap2.c, stdsoap.cpp,
stdsoap2.cpp, soapcpp2.h, soapcpp2.c, soapcpp2_lex.l, soapcpp2_yacc.y, error2.h,
error2.c, symbol2.c, init2.c,
soapdoc2.html, and soapdoc2.pdf, httpget.h, httpget.c, stl.h, stldeque.h, stllist.h,
stlvector.h, stlset.h.
The Initial Developer of the Original Code is Robert A. van Engelen. Portions created
by Robert A. van Engelen are
Copyright (C) 2001-2004 Robert A. van Engelen, Genivia inc. All Rights Reserved.
Contributor(s):
“________________________.”
[Note: The text of this Exhibit A may differ slightly form the text of the notices in the
Source Code files of the Original code. You should use the text of this Exhibit A rather
than the text found in the Original Code Source Code for Your Modifications.]
EXHIBIT B.
“Part of the software embedded in this product is gSOAP software.
viii
Portions created by gSOAP are Copyright (C) 2001-2009 Robert A. van Engelen,
Genivia inc. All Rights Reserved. THE SOFTWARE IN THIS PRODUCT WAS IN
PART PROVIDED BY GENIVIA INC AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS
OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.”
http://www.cs.fsu.edu/~engelen/license.html
■ About gcc libgcc, gcc libstdc++
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 3, 29 June 2007
Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document,
but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for software and other
kinds of works.
The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed to take away
your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, the GNU General Public
License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change all versions of a
program--to make sure it remains free software for all its users. We, the Free Software
Foundation, use the GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies
also to any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to your
programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General
Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute
copies of free software (and charge for them if you wish), that you receive source code
or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new
free programs, and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you these rights or
asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have certain responsibilities if you
distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it: responsibilities to respect the
freedom of others.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee,
you must pass on to the recipients the same freedoms that you received. You must
make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them
these terms so they know their rights.
Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps:
(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License giving you legal
permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it.
For the developers’ and authors’ protection, the GPL clearly explains that there is no
warranty for this free software. For both users’ and authors’ sake, the GPL requires that
modified versions be marked as changed, so that their problems will not be attributed
erroneously to authors of previous versions.
Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run modified versions of
the software inside them, although the manufacturer can do so. This is fundamentally
incompatible with the aim of protecting users’ freedom to change the software. The
systematic pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to use,
which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we have designed this
version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those products. If such problems arise
substantially in other domains, we stand ready to extend this provision to those domains
in future versions of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users.
Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. States should not
allow patents to restrict development and use of software on general-purpose
computers, but in those that do, we wish to avoid the special danger that patents applied
to a free program could make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL
assures that patents cannot be used to render the program non-free.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS
0. Definitions.
“This License” refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License.
“Copyright” also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of works, such as
semiconductor masks.
“The Program” refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this License. Each
licensee is addressed as “you”. “Licensees” and “recipients” may be individuals or
organizations.
To “modify” a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work in a fashion
requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an exact copy. The resulting
work is called a “modified version” of the earlier work or a work “based on” the earlier
work.
A “covered work” means either the unmodified Program or a work based on the
Program.
ix
To “propagate” a work means to do anything with it that, without permission, would
make you directly or secondarily liable for infringement under applicable copyright
law, except executing it on a computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation
includes copying, distribution (with or without modification), making available to the
public, and in some countries other activities as well.
To “convey” a work means any kind of propagation that enables other parties to make
or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through a computer network, with no
transfer of a copy, is not conveying.
An interactive user interface displays “Appropriate Legal Notices” to the extent that it
includes a convenient and prominently visible feature that (1) displays an appropriate
copyright notice, and (2) tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to
the extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the work under this
License, and how to view a copy of this License. If the interface presents a list of user
commands or options, such as a menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion.
1. Source Code.
The “source code” for a work means the preferred form of the work for making
modifications to it. “Object code” means any non-source form of a work.
A “Standard Interface” means an interface that either is an official standard defined by
a recognized standards body, or, in the case of interfaces specified for a particular
programming language, one that is widely used among developers working in that
language.
The “System Libraries” of an executable work include anything, other than the work
as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of packaging a Major Component,
but which is not part of that Major Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the
work with that Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an
implementation is available to the public in source code form. A “Major Component”,
in this context, means a major essential component (kernel, window system, and so on)
of the specific operating system (if any) on which the executable work runs, or a
compiler used to produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
The “Corresponding Source” for a work in object code form means all the source code
needed to generate, install, and (for an executable work) run the object code and to
modify the work, including scripts to control those activities. However, it does not
include the work’s System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available
free programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but which are
not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source includes interface definition
files associated with source files for the work, and the source code for shared libraries
and dynamically linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require,
such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those subprograms
and other parts of the work.
The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users can regenerate
automatically from other parts of the Corresponding Source.
The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that same work.
2. Basic Permissions.
All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of copyright on the
Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated conditions are met. This License
explicitly affirms your unlimited permission to run the unmodified Program. The
output from running a covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given
its content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your rights of fair
use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not convey, without
conditions so long as your license otherwise remains in force. You may convey covered
works to others for the sole purpose of having them make modifications exclusively for
you, or provide you with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply
with the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do not control
copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works for you must do so
exclusively on your behalf, under your direction and control, on terms that prohibit
them from making any copies of your copyrighted material outside their relationship
with you.
Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under the conditions
stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 makes it unnecessary.
3. Protecting Users’ Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological measure under
any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article 11 of the WIPO copyright treaty
adopted on 20 December 1996, or similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention
of such measures.
When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid circumvention
of technological measures to the extent such circumvention is effected by exercising
rights under this License with respect to the covered work, and you disclaim any
intention to limit operation or modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against
the work’s users, your or third parties’ legal rights to forbid circumvention of
technological measures.
4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
You may convey verbatim copies of the Program’s source code as you receive it, in
any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy
an appropriate copyright notice; keep intact all notices stating that this License and any
non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; keep intact all
notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all recipients a copy of this License
along with the Program.
You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, and you may
offer support or warranty protection for a fee.
A “User Product” is either (1) a “consumer product”, which means any tangible
personal property which is normally used for personal, family, or household purposes,
or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation into a dwelling. In determining
whether a product is a consumer product, doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of
coverage. For a particular product received by a particular user, “normally used” refers
to a typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status of the
particular user or of the way in which the particular user actually uses, or expects or is
expected to use, the product. A product is a consumer product regardless of whether the
product has substantial commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses
represent the only significant mode of use of the product.
5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to produce it from
the Program, in the form of source code under the terms of section 4, provided that you
also meet all of these conditions:
a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified it, and giving a
relevant date.
b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is released under this License
and any conditions added under section
7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to “keep intact all notices”.
c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this License to anyone who
comes into possession of a copy. This License will therefore apply, along with any
applicable section 7 additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts,
regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no permission to license the
work in any other way, but it does not invalidate such permission if you have separately
received it.
d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display Appropriate Legal
Notices; however, if the Program has interactive interfaces that do not display
Appropriate Legal Notices, your work need not make them do so.
A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent works, which
are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, and which are not combined
with it such as to form a larger program, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution
medium, is called an “aggregate” if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not
used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation’s users beyond what the
individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work in an aggregate does not cause
this License to apply to the other parts of the aggregate.
6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms of sections 4 and
5, provided that you also convey the machine-readable Corresponding Source under the
terms of this License, in one of these ways:
a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a
physical distribution medium), accompanied by the Corresponding Source fixed on a
durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange.
b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a
physical distribution medium), accompanied by a written offer, valid for at least three
years and valid for as long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product
model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a copy of the
Corresponding Source for all the software in the product that is covered by this License,
on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no
more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this conveying of source, or
(2) access to copy the Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge.
c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the written offer to
provide the Corresponding Source. This alternative is allowed only occasionally and
noncommercially, and
only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord with subsection 6b.
d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated place (gratis or for a
charge), and offer equivalent access to the Corresponding Source in the same way
through the same place at no further charge. You need not require recipients to copy
the Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to copy the object
code is a network server, the Corresponding Source may be on a different server
(operated by you or a third party) that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided
you maintain clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the
Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the Corresponding Source, you
remain obligated to ensure that it is available for as long as needed to satisfy these
requirements.
e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided you inform
other peers where the object code and Corresponding Source of the work are being
offered to the general public at no charge under subsection 6d.
A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded from the
Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be included in conveying the
object code work.
“Installation Information” for a User Product means any methods, procedures,
authorization keys, or other information required to install and execute modified
versions of a covered work in that User Product from a modified version of its
Corresponding Source. The information must suffice to ensure that the continued
functioning of the modified object code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely
because modification has been made.
If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or specifically for use
in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as part of a transaction in which the right
of possession and use of the User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or
for a fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the Corresponding
Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied by the Installation
Information. But this requirement does not apply if neither you nor any third party
retains the ability to install modified object code on the User Product (for example, the
work has been installed in ROM).
The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a requirement to
continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates for a work that has been
modified or installed by the recipient, or for the User Product in which it has been
modified or installed. Access to a network may be denied when the modification itself
materially and adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and
protocols for communication across the network.
Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, in accord
with this section must be in a format that is publicly documented (and with an
implementation available to the public in source code form), and must require no
special password or key for unpacking, reading or copying.
7. Additional Terms.
“Additional permissions” are terms that supplement the terms of thisLicense by
making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. Additional permissions that are
applicable to the entire Program shall be treated as though they were included in this
License, to the extent that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions
apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately under those
permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by this License without regard to
the additional permissions.
When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option remove any
additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of it. (Additional permissions
may be written to require their own removal in certain cases when you modify the
work.) You may place additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered
work, for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you add to a covered
work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of that material) supplement the
terms of this License with terms:
a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the terms of sections 15
and 16 of this License; or
b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or author attributions
in that material or in the Appropriate Legal Notices displayed by works containing it; or
c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or requiring that
modified versions of such material be marked in reasonable ways as different from the
original version; or
d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or authors of the
material; or
e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some trade names,
trademarks, or service marks; or
f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that material by anyone who
conveys the material (or modified versions of it) with contractual assumptions of
liability to the recipient, for any liability that these contractual assumptions directly
impose on those licensors and authors.
All other non-permissive additional terms are considered “further restrictions” within
the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you received it, or any part of it, contains
a notice stating that it is governed by this License along with a term that is a further
restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains a further
restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this License, you may add to a
covered work material governed by the terms of that license document, provided that
the further restriction does not survive such relicensing or conveying.
If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you must place, in the
relevant source files, a statement of the additional terms that apply to those files, or a
notice indicating where to find the applicable terms.
x
Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the form of a
separately written license, or stated as exceptions; the above requirements apply either
way.
You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly provided under
this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or modify it is void, and will
automatically terminate your rights under this License (including any patent licenses
granted under the third
paragraph of section 11).
If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, and the
Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone to copy, free of charge
and under the terms of this License, through a publicly available network server or
other readily accessible means, then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding
Source to be so available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the patent
license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner consistent with the
requirements of this License, to extend the patent license to downstream recipients.
“Knowingly relying” means you have actual knowledge that, but for the patent license,
your conveying the covered work in a country, or your recipient’s use of the covered
work in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that country that
you have reason to believe are valid.
However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular
copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder
explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright
holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days
after the cessation.
If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or arrangement, you convey,
or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a covered work, and grant a patent license to
some of the parties receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate,
modify or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license you grant
is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered work and works based on it.
Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if
the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the
first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the
notice.
A patent license is “discriminatory” if it does not include within the scope of its
coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more
of the rights that are specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a
covered work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is in the
business of distributing software, under which you make payment to the third party
based on the extent of your activity of conveying the work, and under which the third
party grants, to any of the parties who would receive the covered work from you, a
discriminatory patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work
conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily for and in
connection with specific products or compilations that contain the covered work, unless
you entered into that arrangement, or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March
2007.
8. Termination.
Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties
who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have
been terminated and not permanently reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new
licenses for the same material under section 10.
9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or run a copy of the
Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work occurring solely as a consequence
of using peer-to-peer transmission to receive a copy likewise does not require
acceptance. However, nothing other than this License grants you permission to
propagate or modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do not
accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a covered work, you
indicate your acceptance of this License to do so.
10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically receives a license
from the original licensors, to run, modify and propagate that work, subject to this
License. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this
License.
An “entity transaction” is a transaction transferring control of an organization, or
substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an organization, or merging organizations.
If propagation of a covered work results from an entity transaction, each party to that
transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever licenses to the work
the party’s predecessor in interest had or could give under the previous paragraph, plus
a right to possession of the Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in
interest, if the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the rights granted or
affirmed under this License. For example, you may not impose a license fee, royalty, or
other charge for exercise of rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate
litigation (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that any patent
claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for sale, or importing the Program
or any portion of it.
11. Patents.
A “contributor” is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this License of the
Program or a work on which the Program is based. The work thus licensed is called the
contributor’s “contributor version”.
A contributor’s “essential patent claims” are all patent claims owned or controlled by
the contributor, whether already acquired or hereafter acquired, that would be infringed
by some manner, permitted by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor
version, but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a consequence of
further modification of the contributor version. For purposes of this definition,
“control” includes the right to grant patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the
requirements of this License.
Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free patent license
under the contributor’s essential patent claims, to make, use, sell, offer for sale, import
and otherwise run, modify and propagate the contents of its contributor version.
In the following three paragraphs, a “patent license” is any express agreement or
commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent (such as an express
permission to practice a patent or covenant not to sue for patent infringement). To
“grant” such a patent license to a party means to make such an agreement or
commitment not to enforce a patent against the party.
Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting any implied license
or other defenses to infringement that may otherwise be available to you under
applicable patent law.
12. No Surrender of Others’ Freedom.
If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise)
that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the
conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a covered work so as to satisfy
simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations,
then as a consequence you may not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms
that obligate you to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you
convey the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this License
would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have permission to link or
combine any covered work with a work licensed under version 3 of the GNU Affero
General Public License into a single combined work, and to convey the resulting work.
The terms of this License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work,
but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License, section 13,
concerning interaction through a network will apply to the combination as such.
14. Revised Versions of this License.
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the GNU
General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to
the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies that a
certain numbered version of the GNU General Public License “or any later version”
applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that
numbered version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If
the Program does not specify a version number of the GNU General Public License,
you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of the GNU
General Public License can be used, that proxy’s public statement of acceptance of a
version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Program.
Later license versions may give you additional or different permissions. However, no
additional obligations are imposed on any author or copyright holder as a result of your
choosing to follow a later version.
15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED
IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
PROVIDE THE PROGRAM “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM
PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY
SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. Limitation of Liability.
xi
IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO
IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO
MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE
LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE
OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES
SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM
TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGES.
17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided above cannot be given
local legal effect according to their terms, reviewing courts shall apply local law that
most closely approximates an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the
Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a copy of the
Program in return for a fee.
0. Definitions.
A file is an “Independent Module” if it either requires the Runtime Library for
execution after a Compilation Process, or makes use of an interface provided by the
Runtime Library, but is not otherwise based on the Runtime Library.
“GCC” means a version of the GNU Compiler Collection, with or without
modifications, governed by version 3 (or a specified later version) of the GNU General
Public License (GPL) with the option of using any subsequent versions published by
the FSF.
“GPL-compatible Software” is software whose conditions of propagation, modification
and use would permit combination with GCC in accord with the license of GCC.
“Target Code” refers to output from any compiler for a real or virtual target processor
architecture, in executable form or suitable for input to an assembler, loader, linker and/
or execution phase.
Notwithstanding that, Target Code does not include data in any format that is used as a
compiler intermediate representation, or used for producing a compiler intermediate
representation.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the
public, the best way to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can
redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the
start of each source file to most effectively state the exclusion of warranty; and each file
should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
<one line to give the program’s name and a brief idea of what it does.>
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms
of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation,
either version 3 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License for
more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with this
program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
The “Compilation Process” transforms code entirely represented in non-intermediate
languages designed for human-written code, and/or in Java Virtual Machine byte code,
into Target Code. Thus, for example, use of source code generators and preprocessors
need not be considered part of the Compilation Process, since the Compilation Process
can be understood as starting with the output of the generators or preprocessors.
A Compilation Process is “Eligible” if it is done using GCC, alone or with other GPLcompatible software, or if it is done without using any work based on GCC. For
example, using non-GPL-compatible Software to optimize any GCC intermediate
representations would not qualify as an Eligible Compilation Process.
1. Grant of Additional Permission.
You have permission to propagate a work of Target Code formed by combining the
Runtime Library with Independent Modules, even if such propagation would otherwise
violate the terms of GPLv3, provided that all Target Code was generated by Eligible
Compilation Processes.
You may then convey such a combination under terms of your choice, consistent with
the licensing of the Independent Modules.
2. No Weakening of GCC Copyleft.
The availability of this Exception does not imply any general presumption that thirdparty software is unaffected by the copyleft requirements of the license of GCC.
■ About c-ares
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
Copyright 1998 by the Massachusetts Institute of Technology.
If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short notice like this when it
starts in an interactive mode:
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its documentation for
any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice
appear in all copies and that both that copyright notice and this permission notice
appear in supporting documentation, and that the name of M.I.T. not be used in
advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific,
written prior permission.
M.I.T. makes no representations about the suitability of this software for any purpose. It
is provided “as is” without express or implied warranty.
<program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show
w’.
This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions;
type `show c’ for details.
The hypothetical commands `show w’ and `show c’ should show the appropriate parts
of the General Public License. Of course, your program’s commands might be
different; for a GUI interface, you would use an “about box”.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, if any, to
sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the program, if necessary.
For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see
<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
■ About WPA Supplicant
WPA Supplicant
Copyright (c) 2003-2012, Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi> and contributors
All Rights Reserved.
This program is licensed under the BSD license (the one with advertisement clause
removed).
The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more
useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you
want to do, use the GNU Lesser General Public License instead of this License. But
first, please read
<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>.
If you are submitting changes to the project, please see CONTRIBUTIONS file for
more instructions.
GCC RUNTIME LIBRARY EXCEPTION
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
Version 3.1, 31 March 2009
Copyright c 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document,
but changing it is not allowed.
This GCC Runtime Library Exception (“Exception”) is an additional permission under
section 7 of the GNU General Public License, version 3 (“GPLv3”). It applies to a
given file (the “Runtime Library”) that bears a notice placed by the copyright holder of
the file stating that the file is governed by GPLv3 along with this Exception.
When you use GCC to compile a program, GCC may combine portions of certain GCC
header files and runtime libraries with the compiled program. The purpose of this
Exception is to allow compilation of non-GPL (including proprietary) programs to use,
in this way, the header files and runtime libraries covered by this Exception.
License
This software may be distributed, used, and modified under the terms of BSD license:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.
3. Neither the name(s) of the above-listed copyright holder(s) nor the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
without specific prior written permission.
xii
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
■ About libxml2
Except where otherwise noted in the source code (e.g. the files hash.c, list.c and the trio
files, which are covered by a similar licence but with different Copyright notices) all the
files are:
Copyright (C) 1998-2003 Daniel Veillard. All Rights Reserved.
Arev Fonts Copyright
-----------------------------Copyright (c) 2006 by Tavmjong Bah. All Rights Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of the fonts
accompanying this license (“Fonts”) and associated documentation files (the “Font
Software”), to reproduce and distribute the modifications to the Bitstream Vera Font
Software, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, merge, publish,
distribute, and/or sell copies of the Font Software, and to permit persons to whom the
Font Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright and trademark notices and this permission notice shall be included
in all copies of one or more of the Font Software typefaces.
The Font Software may be modified, altered, or added to, and in particular the designs
of glyphs or characters in the Fonts may be modified and additional glyphs or
characters may be added to the Fonts, only if the fonts are renamed to names not
containing either the words “Tavmjong Bah” or the word “Arev”.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this
software and associated documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in the Software
without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons
to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
This License becomes null and void to the extent applicable to Fonts or Font Software
that has been modified and is distributed under the “Tavmjong Bah Arev” names.
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or
substantial portions of the Software.
THE FONT SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF COPYRIGHT, PATENT,
TRADEMARK, OR OTHER RIGHT. IN NO EVENT SHALL TAVMJONG BAH BE
LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, INCLUDING
ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR
OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
FONT SOFTWARE OR FROM OTHER DEALINGS IN THE FONT SOFTWARE.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE DANIEL
VEILLARD BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
The Font Software may be sold as part of a larger software package but no copy of one
or more of the Font Software typefaces may be sold by itself.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of Daniel Veillard shall not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software
without prior written authorization from him.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of Tavmjong Bah shall not be used in
advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Font Software
without prior written authorization from Tavmjong Bah. For further information,
contact: tavmjong @ free. fr.
■ About fonts
■ About FLAC codec library
Fonts are (c) Bitstream (see below). DejaVu changes are in public domain.
Glyphs imported from Arev fonts are (c) Tavmjong Bah (see below)
Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Josh Coalson
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
– Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
– Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.
– Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the names of its contributors may
be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific
prior written permission.
Bitstream Vera Fonts Copyright
-----------------------------Copyright (c) 2003 by Bitstream, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Bitstream Vera is a
trademark of Bitstream, Inc.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of the fonts
accompanying this license (“Fonts”) and associated documentation files (the “Font
Software”), to reproduce and distribute the Font Software, including without limitation
the rights to use, copy, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of the Font
Software, and to permit persons to whom the Font Software is furnished to do so,
subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright and trademark notices and this permission notice shall be included
in all copies of one or more of the Font Software typefaces.
The Font Software may be modified, altered, or added to, and in particular the designs
of glyphs or characters in the Fonts may be modified and additional glyphs or
characters may be added to the Fonts, only if the fonts are renamed to names not
containing either the words “Bitstream” or the word “Vera”.
This License becomes null and void to the extent applicable to Fonts or Font Software
that has been modified and is distributed under the “Bitstream Vera” names.
The Font Software may be sold as part of a larger software package but no copy of one
or more of the Font Software typefaces may be sold by itself.
THE FONT SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF COPYRIGHT, PATENT,
TRADEMARK, OR OTHER RIGHT. IN NO EVENT SHALL BITSTREAM OR THE
GNOME FOUNDATION BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO
USE THE FONT SOFTWARE OR FROM OTHER DEALINGS IN THE FONT
SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the names of Gnome, the Gnome Foundation, and
Bitstream Inc., shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or
other dealings in this Font Software without prior written authorization from the Gnome
Foundation or Bitstream Inc., respectively. For further information, contact: fonts at
gnome dot org.
xiii
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS
OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
CAUTION
Use of controls or adjustments or performance of
procedures other than those specified herein may result
in hazardous radiation exposure.
PRECAUCIÓN
El uso de los controles, los ajustes o los procedimientos
que no se especifican enste manual pueden causar una
exposición peligrosa a la radiación.
LASER Specification:
Class 1 LASER Product
Wave length: 790 nm (CDs)/658 nm (DVDs)/405 nm (BDs)
Laser output: max. 1 mW
Especificaciones LÁSER:
Producto LÁSER de Clase 1
Longitud de onda: 790 nm (CD)/658 nm (DVD)/405 nm (BD)
Salida de láser: máxima de 1 mW
LASER SAFETY
This unit employs a laser. Due to possible eye injury, only
a qualified service person should remove the cover or
attempt to service this device.
CAUTION: INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION WHEN OPEN.
DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM.
DANGER: INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION WHEN OPEN.
AVOID DIRECT EXPOSURE TO THE BEAM.
DANGER
This unit emits visible laser radiation when open. Avoid
direct eye exposure to beam. When this unit is plugged
into the wall outlet, do not place your eyes close to the
opening of the disc tray and other openings to look into
inside.
SEGURIDAD CONTRA LA RADIACIÓN LÁSER
Este aparato utiliza rayos láser. Debido a la posibilidad de
que se produzcan daños en los ojos, la extracción de la
cubierta del aparato o las reparaciones solamente deberán ser
realizadas por un técnico cualificado.
PELIGRO
Este aparato emite radiación láser visible cuando se abre.
Evite la exposición directa a los rayos láser. Cuando se
conecte este aparato a una toma de corriente no acerque sus
ojos a la abertura de la bandeja del disco ni a otras aberturas
para mirar al interior.
Yamaha de México, S.A. de C.V.
Eje 5 Ote. Javier Rojo Gomez 1149,
Iztapalapa, D.F., México
Tel: 52-55-5804-0600
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.
Torre Banco General Piso 7,
Marbella Calle 47 y Aquilino de la Guardia,
Ciudad de Panamá, Panamá
Tel: 507-269-5311
xiv
P
Blu-ray Disc Player
BD-S673
BD-S673
Owner’s Manual
Manual de Instrucciones
English
Español
USB
© 2012 Yamaha Corporation
Printed in China BD-S673/P
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertising